Bridge Design
Bridge Design
Bridge Design
Worked examples
Worked examples presented at the Workshop Bridge Design to Eurocodes, Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
Support to the implementation, harmonization and further development of the Eurocodes
Y. Bouassida, E. Bouchon, P. Crespo, P. Croce, L. Davaine, S. Denton, M. Feldmann, R. Frank,
G. Hanswille, W. Hensen, B. Kolias, N. Malakatas, G. Mancini, M. Ortega, J. Raoul, G. Sedlacek, G. Tsionis
Editors
A. Athanasopoulou, M. Poljansek, A. Pinto
G. Tsionis, S. Denton
The mission of the JRC is to provide customer-driven scientific and technical support for the
conception, development, implementation and monitoring of EU policies. As a service of the
European Commission, the JRC functions as a reference centre of science and technology for
the Union. Close to the policy-making process, it serves the common interest of the Member
States, while being independent of special interests, whether private or national.
European Commission
Joint Research Centre
Contact information
Address: JRC, ELSA Unit, TP 480, I-21027, Ispra (VA), Italy
E-mail: eurocodes@jrc.ec.europa.eu
Tel.: +39-0332-789989
Fax: +39-0332-789049
http://www.jrc.ec.europa.eu/
Legal Notice
Neither the European Commission nor any person acting on behalf of the Commission
is responsible for the use which might be made of this publication.
Europe Direct is a service to help you find answers
to your questions about the European Union
Freephone number (*):
00 800 6 7 8 9 10 11
(*) Certain mobile telephone operators do not allow access to 00 800 numbers or these calls may be billed.
A great deal of additional information on the European Union is available on the Internet.
It can be accessed through the Europa server http://europa.eu/
JRC 68415
EUR 25193 EN
ISBN 978-92-79-22823-0
ISSN 1831-9424
doi: 10.2788/82360
Luxembourg: Publications Office of the European Union, 2012
European Union, 2012
Reproduction is authorised provided the source is acknowledged
Printed in Italy
Acknowledgements
The work presented in this report is a deliverable within the framework of the Administrative
Arrangement SI2.558935 under the Memorandum of Understanding between the Directorate-General
for Enterprise and Industry of the European Commission (DG ENTR) and the Joint Research Centre
(JRC) on the support to the implementation, harmonisation and further development of the
Eurocodes.
ii
Table of Contents
Acknowledgements
Table of contents
iii
xi
Foreword
xiii
Introduction
xv
Chapter 1
Introduction to the design example
1.1 Introduction
1.3.1 PIERS
1.3.2 ABUTMENTS
1.3.3 BEARINGS
10
11
11
11
1.5 Materials
11
12
12
15
iii
16
16
16
Chapter 2
Basis of design (EN 1990)
2.1 Introduction
21
21
21
22
22
23
23
24
2.5.1 ACTIONS
24
25
26
2.7 EN 1990 Section 6 Limit states design and Annex A2 Application for bridges
26
26
27
27
28
29
31
2.8 Conclusions
32
33
CHAPTER 3
Actions on bridge deck and piers (EN 1991)
Part A: Wind and thermal action on bridge deck and piers
3.1 Introduction
37
37
iv
40
40
43
43
45
46
46
46
47
48
3.6 Introduction
50
50
52
55
56
56
57
58
60
61
65
67
CHAPTER 4
Bridge deck modelling and structural analysis
4.1 Introduction
79
79
79
80
81
81
81
83
83
84
85
4.5.1 SELF-WEIGHT
85
85
86
87
90
91
4.7.1 VERTICAL SUPPORT REACTIONS
92
92
92
CHAPTER 5
93
97
97
97
99
116
118
121
121
122
122
vi
CHAPTER 6
Composite bridge design (EN 1994-2)
6.1 Verification of cross-section at mid-span P1-P2
127
127
127
130
132
132
132
134
139
142
144
144
145
145
145
146
147
150
151
151
151
152
153
155
156
156
157
vii
160
163
165
166
171
CHAPTER 7
Geotechnical aspects of bridge design (EN 1997)
7.1 Introduction
177
177
183
183
185
7.4 Abutment C0
189
189
192
193
193
195
196
CHAPTER 8
Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2)
8.1 Introduction
201
201
201
203
205
206
209
219
viii
224
224
224
225
226
237
239
241
241
247
249
253
257
262
269
271
278
279
APPENDICES
283
APPENDIX A
A-1
B-1
C-1
D-1
ix
xi
Editors
Adamantia Athanasopoulou, Martin Poljansek, Artur Pinto
European Laboratory for Structural Assessment
Institute for the Protection and Security of the Citizen
Joint Research Centre, European Commission
xii
Foreword
The construction sector is of strategic importance to the EU as it delivers the buildings and
infrastructure needed by the rest of the economy and society. It represents more than 10% of EU
GDP and more than 50% of fixed capital formation. It is the largest single economic activity and
the biggest industrial employer in Europe. The sector employs directly almost 20 million people. In
addition, construction is a key element for the implementation of the Single Market and other
construction relevant EU Policies, e.g.: Environment and Energy.
In line with the EUs strategy for smart, sustainable and inclusive growth (EU2020), Standardization
will play an important part in supporting the strategy. The EN Eurocodes are a set of European
standards which provide common rules for the design of construction works, to check their strength
and stability against live and extreme loads such as earthquakes and fire.
With the publication of all the 58 Eurocodes parts in 2007, the implementation of the Eurocodes is
extending to all European countries and there are firm steps towards their adoption internationally.
The Commission Recommendation of 11 December 2003 stresses the importance of training in the
use of the Eurocodes, especially in engineering schools and as part of continuous professional
development courses for engineers and technicians, noting that they should be promoted both at
national and international level.
In light of the Recommendation, DG JRC is collaborating with DG ENTR and CEN/TC250 Structural
Eurocodes and is publishing the Report Series Support to the implementation, harmonization
and further development of the Eurocodes as JRC Scientific and Technical Reports. This Report
Series include, at present, the following types of reports:
1.
Policy support documents Resulting from the work of the JRC and cooperation with partners
and stakeholders on Support to the implementation, promotion and further development of
the Eurocodes and other standards for the building sector.
2.
Technical documents Facilitating the implementation and use of the Eurocodes and
containing information and practical examples (Worked Examples) on the use of the
Eurocodes and covering the design of structures or their parts (e.g. the technical reports
containing the practical examples presented in the workshops on the Eurocodes with worked
examples organized by the JRC).
3.
Pre-normative documents Resulting from the works of the CEN/TC250 Working Groups and
containing background information and/or first draft of proposed normative parts. These
documents can be then converted to CEN technical specifications.
4.
5.
Editorial work for this Report Series is assured by the JRC together with partners and stakeholders,
when appropriate. The publication of the reports type 3, 4 and 5 is made after approval for publication
from the CEN/TC250 Co-ordination Group.
The publication of these reports by the JRC serves the purpose of implementation, further
harmonization and development of the Eurocodes, However, it is noted that neither the Commission
nor CEN are obliged to follow or endorse any recommendation or result included in these reports in
the European legislation or standardization processes.
xiii
This report is part of the so-called Technical documents (Type 2 above) and contains a
comprehensive description of the practical examples presented at the workshop Bridge
Design to the Eurocodes with emphasis on worked examples of bridge design. The workshop
was held on 4-6 October 2010 in Vienna, Austria and was co-organized with CEN/TC250/Horizontal
Group Bridges, the Austrian Federal Ministry for Transport, Innovation and Technology and the
Austrian Standards Institute, with the support of CEN and the Member States. The workshop
addressed representatives of public authorities, national standardisation bodies, research institutions,
academia, industry and technical associations involved in training on the Eurocodes. The main
objective was to facilitate training on Eurocode Parts related to Bridge Design through the transfer of
knowledge and training information from the Eurocode Bridge Parts writers (CEN/TC250 Horizontal
Group Bridges) to key trainers at national level and Eurocode users.
The workshop was a unique occasion to compile a state-of-the-art training kit comprising the slide
presentations and technical papers with the worked example for a bridge structure designed following
the Eurocodes. The present JRC Report compiles all the technical papers prepared by the workshop
lecturers resulting in the presentation of a bridge structure analyzed from the point of view of each
Eurocode.
The editors and authors have sought to present useful and consistent information in this
report. However, it must be noted that the report is not a complete design example and that the
reader may identify some discrepancies between chapters. Users of information contained in
this report must satisfy themselves of its suitability for the purpose for which they intend to
use it. It is also noted that the chapters presented in the report have been prepared by different
authors, and reflecting the different practices in the EU Member States both . and , are used as
decimal separators.
We would like to gratefully acknowledge the workshop lecturers and the members of CEN/TC250
Horizontal Group Bridges for their contribution in the organization of the workshop and development
of the training material comprising the slide presentations and technical papers with the worked
examples. We would also like to thank the Austrian Federal Ministry for Transport, Innovation and
Technology, especially Dr. Eva M. Eichinger-Vill, and the Austrian Standards Institute for their help
and support in the local organization of the workshop.
All the material prepared for the workshop (slides presentations and JRC Report) is available to
download from the Eurocodes: Building the future website (http://eurocodes.jrc.ec.europa.eu).
xiv
Introduction
The Eurocodes are currently in the process of national implementation towards becoming the Europewide means for structural design of civil engineering works.
As part of the strategy and general programme for promotion and training on the Eurocodes, a
workshop on bridge design to Eurocodes was organised in Vienna in October 2010. The main
objective of this workshop was to transfer background knowledge and expertise. The workshop aimed
to provide state-of-the-art training material and background information on Eurocodes, with an
emphasis on practical worked examples.
This report collects together the material that was prepared and presented at the workshop by a
group of experts who have been actively involved in the development of the Eurocodes. It
summarises important points of the Eurocodes for the design of concrete, steel and composite road
bridges, including foundations and seismic design. The worked examples utilise a common bridge
project as a basis, although inevitably, they are not exhaustive.
From March 2010, the Eurocodes were intended to be the only Standards for the design of structures
in the countries of the European Union (EU) and the European Free Trade Association (EFTA). The
Member States of the EU and EFTA recognise that the Eurocodes serve as:
a means to prove compliance of buildings and civil engineering works with the essential
requirements of the Construction Products Directive (Directive 89/106/EEC), particularly Essential
Requirement 1 Mechanical resistance and stability and Essential Requirement 2 Safety in case
of fire;
a basis for specifying contracts for construction works and related engineering services;
xv
a framework for drawing up harmonised technical specifications for construction products (ENs
and ETAs).
The Eurocodes were developed under the guidance and co-ordination of CEN/TC250 Structural
Eurocodes. The role of CEN/TC250 and its subcommittees is to manage all the work for the
Eurocodes and to oversee their implementation. The Horizontal Group Bridges was established within
CEN/TC250 with the purpose of facilitating technical liaison on matters related to bridges and to
support the wider strategy of CEN/TC250. In this context, the strategy for the Horizontal Group
Bridges embraces the following work streams: maintenance and evolution of Eurocodes, development
of National Annexes and harmonisation, promotion (training/guidance and international), future
developments and promotion of research needs.
Bridge Parts of the Eurocodes
Each Eurocode, except EN 1990, is divided into a number of parts that cover specific aspects. The
Eurocodes for concrete, steel, composite and timber structures and for seismic design comprise a
Part 2 which covers explicitly the design of road and railway bridges. These parts are intended to be
used for the design of new bridges, including piers, abutments, upstand walls, wing walls and flank
walls etc., and their foundations. The materials covered are i) plain, reinforced and prestressed
concrete made with normal and light-weight aggregates, ii) steel, iii) steel-concrete composites and iv)
timber or other wood-based materials, either singly or compositely with concrete, steel or other
materials. Cable-stayed and arch bridges are not fully covered. Suspension bridges, timber and
masonry bridges, moveable bridges and floating bridges are excluded from the scope of Part 2 of
Eurocode 8.
A bridge designer should use EN 1990 for the basis of design, together with EN 1991 for actions, EN
1992 to EN 1995 (depending on the material) for the structural design and detailing, EN 1997 for
geotechnical aspects and EN 1998 for design against earthquakes. The main Eurocode parts used for
the design of concrete, steel and composite bridges are given in Table II.
The ten Eurocodes are part of the broader family of European standards, which also include material,
product and execution standards. The Eurocodes are intended to be used together with such
normative documents and, through reference to them, adopt some of their provisions. Fig. I
schematically illustrates the use of Eurocodes together with material (e.g. concrete and steel), product
(e.g. bearings, barriers and parapets) and execution standards for the design and construction of a
bridge.
xvi
Table II: Overview of principal Eurocode parts used for the design of concrete, steel and
composite bridges and bridge elements
EN Part
EN 1990
EN 1990/A1
EN 1991-1-1
EN 1991-1-3
EN 1991-1-4
EN 1991-1-5
EN 1991-1-6
EN 1991-1-7
EN 1991-2
EN 1992-1-1
EN 1992-2
EN 1993-1-1
EN 1993-1-5
EN 1993-1-7
EN 1993-1-8
EN 1993-1-9
EN 1993-1-10
EN 1993-1-11
EN 1993-1-12
EN 1993-2
EN 1993-5
EN 1994-1-1
EN 1994-2
EN 1997-1
EN 1997-2
EN 1998-1
EN 1998-2
EN 1998-5
Scope
Basis of design
Bridges
Self-weight
Snow loads
Wind actions
Thermal actions
Actions during execution
Accidental actions
Traffic loads
General rules
Bridges
General rules
Plated elements
Out-of-plane loading
Joints
Fatigue
Material toughness
Tension components
Transversely loaded plated structures
Bridges
Piling
General rules
Bridges
General rules
Testing
General rules, seismic actions
Bridges
Foundations
Figure I: Use of Eurocodes with product, material and execution standards for a bridge
xvii
xviii
composite cross-sections, the ULS, SLS and fatigue verifications and the detailed design for creep
and shrinkage. Chapter 7 presents the settlement and resistance calculations for the pier, three
design approaches for the abutment and the verification of the foundation for the seismic design
situation. Finally, Chapter 8 is concerned with the conceptual design for earthquake resistance
considering the alternative solutions of slender or squat piers; the latter case involves seismic
isolation and design for ductile behaviour.
xix
xx
CHAPTER 1
Laurence DAVAINE
French Railway Bridge Engineering Department (SNCF, IGOA)
1.1 Introduction
The main characteristics of the bridge worked out in the following chapters are presented here. The
dimensions of the deck and the substructure, the constituent materials, the construction process and
the relevant design assumptions are summarized in this chapter.
There is a main example which is analysed from the point of view of each Eurocode all along this
Report. However, where an author has considered of interest to highlight some specific aspect, a
partial alternative example has been developed to explain the relevant issue. These alternative
examples, like different cross-sections of the deck, different pier heights or bearing configurations are
presented here as well.
IPE 600
2500
7000
2500
1100
600
2800
1100
2800
12000
0,50
Bottom concrete
7000
2.5
2
1.5
1
0.5
0
0
20
40
60
80
100
120
140
160
180
200
1.3.2 ABUTMENTS
The abutments geometry is represented in Fig. 1.7.
1.3.3 BEARINGS
1.3.3.1 For the squat piers case
There are two bearings at each abutment and pier with non-linear friction behaviour in both,
longitudinal and transverse direction (Triple Friction Pendulum System, FPS).
The bearing dimensions are:
o
C0_L
P1_L
P2_L
C3_L
C0_R
P1_R
P2_R
C3_R
Abutment
Pier 1
Pier 2
Abutment
At piers: a fixed articulated connection on the right side and an articulated connection on the
left side, fixed in the longitudinal direction and free in the transverse.
At abutments: a displacement-free bearing in both directions on the left side and transversally
restraint on the right side.
C0_L
P1_L
P2_L
C3_L
C0_R
P1_ R
P2_ R
C3_ R
Abutment
Pier 1
Pier 2
Abutment
Safety barrier
Concrete support
for the safety barrier
3.50
0.40
0.25
2.5%
2.00
0.3075
3.50
0.28
2.00
2.5%
Girder no 2
Girder no 1
2.50
2.00
2.00
7.00
12.00
2.50
10
XC3 for the top face of the concrete slab (under the waterproofing layer)
High piers (H=40 m) with longitudinal fixed connection between piers and deck
For the seismic analysis, the ground under the bridge is considered to be formed by deposits of very
dense sand (it can be identified as ground type B, according to EN 1998-1, Table 3.1).
The bridge has a medium importance for the communications system after an earthquake, so the
importance factor I will be taken equal to 1.0.
No special regional seismic situation is considered.
For the squat piers case, the reference peak ground acceleration will be agR = 0.40g.
For the high piers case, the reference peak ground acceleration will be agR = 0.30g. In this case, a
limited elastic behavior is selected and, according to Table 4.1 of EN 1998-2, the behaviour factor is
taken q = 1.5 (reinforced concrete piers).
1.5 Materials
a) Structural steel
For the structural steel of the deck, grade S355 is used with the subgrades indicated in Table 1.1,
depending on the plate thickness.
11
Subgrade
30 mm
S 355 K2
30
80 mm
S 355 N
80
135 mm
S 355 NL
b) Concrete
Concrete class C35/45 is used for all the concrete elements in the example (deck slab, piers,
abutments and foundations).
c) Reinforcing steel
The reinforcing bars used in the example are class B high bond bars with a yield strength
fsk = 500 MPa.
d) Shear connectors
Stud shear connectors in S235J2G3 steel grade are adopted. Their ultimate strength is f u = 450 MPa.
12
13
The transverse girders in span are made of IPE600 rolled sections whereas the transverse girders at
internal supports and abutments are built-up welded sections. The vertical T-shaped stiffeners are
duplicated and welded on the lower flange at supports whereas the flange of the vertical T-shaped
stiffeners in span has a V-shaped cut-out for fatigue reasons.
1500
2800
40
7000
300
1500
400
30
300
20
400
50
150
Section A-A
Section B-B
Fig. 1.13 Detailing of transverse cross-bracing at supports
14
30
1100
600
2800
1100
IPE 600
7000
Section B-B
Section C-C
19
Section A-A
300
30
600
300
220
20
400
12
50
60
150
100
220
50
In span regions:
15
b)
AT SUPPORT
IN SPAN
130 mm
20 s=170 mm
16 s=130 mm
20 s=130 mm
20 s=170 mm
16 s=170 mm
12 with variable spacing to
be adapted with stud spacing
16 s=130 mm
25 s=170 mm
12 with variable spacing to
16 s=130 mm be adapted with stud spacing
16 s=170 mm
16
16
Scale:
2/1
Note: The vertical reinforcement (to maintain bars during concreting) and the reinforcement for the longitudinal concrete supports of the safety barriers are not shown.
1/1
16
2
Segment length = 12.50 m
60.00 m
16
15
14
13
12
80.00 m
200.00 m
17
11
10
60.00 m
18
CHAPTER 2
20
2.1
Introduction
EN 1990:2002 was the first of the Eurocodes published, and it is frequently referred to as the head
Eurocode. This is because EN 1990:2002 essentially serves a dual role, and understanding this fact is
very helpful in understanding the Standard.
As would be expected, EN 1990:2002 sets out principles and requirements to be applied by
designers. In addition, it also establishes the overall framework of tools and principles used by the
drafters of the other Eurocode parts.
As a result, EN 1990:2002 includes some very general statements, such as clause 2.1(2)P which
states that a structure shall be designed to have adequate structural resistance, serviceability, and
durability. Whilst this is clearly an entirely sensible statement, EN 1990:2002 gives little guidance on
how this should actually be done. Once designers are familiar with the full Eurocode suite this is not a
problem, because the means of fulfilling such general principles are given in the other Eurocode parts.
It is sometimes helpful to think of EN 1990:2002 as a toolbox providing the tools that are then used
by the other Eurocode parts. This can make reading EN 1990 in isolation rather tricky as it is not
always immediately clear how the tools it creates are to be deployed. This chapter aims to help with
that challenge, and serve as a general introduction to the principles, terminology and notation used
throughout this report.
It does so by providing an overview of EN 1990:2002 following its structure and drawing out important
issues. In doing so, six key concepts are identified that bridge designers should understand. These
are: design situations; reversible and irreversible serviceability limit states; representative values of
variable actions; the six different ultimate limit states; the single source principle; and the five general
expressions for the combination of actions. A summary of each of these concepts is provided in
Section 2.9.
2.2
Section 1 of EN 1990:2002 sets out its scope and assumptions. It also contains definitions and
notation. It is noteworthy that the scope of EN 1990:2002 includes structural design of civil
engineering works, including execution and temporary structures, i.e. temporary works (clause
1.1(2)), and also that it includes the structural appraisal of existing construction, in developing the
design of repairs and alterations or in assessing changes of use (clause 1.1(4)). However, there is an
important note below this latter clause that explains that additional or amended provisions may be
required for this purpose, which enables countries to maintain the use of any existing assessment
standards for bridges.
It is also worth noting that the assumptions given in clause 1.3(2) are quite onerous and impact the
designer, contractor and client. They include requirements for competency and quality control.
21
The basic requirements include the three stated in clause 2.1(2)P. These are that the structure should
be designed to have adequate structural resistance, serviceability, and durability. There is, however,
effectively a fourth basic requirement embodied in clause 2.1(4)P which states that a structure shall
be designed and executed in such a way that it will not be damaged by eventsto an extent
disproportionate to the original cause. This clause requires structures to be robust, and designers
should be very mindful of this fundamental requirement, particularly when designing structures with
complicated structural forms, when using brittle (or quasi-brittle) materials, components or
connections, and in structures with limited redundancy (i.e. without alternative load paths).
22
In bridge design identifying whether a design situation is accidental, seismic, transient or persistent is
usually straightforward. If the situation involves an accidental action then it is an accidental design
situation. If the situation involves an earthquake then it is a seismic design situation. If not, and the
structure is itself in some special configuration for a short period of time, then it is a transient design
situation. And if it is not a transient design situation, it will be a persistent design situation.
23
2.5.1 ACTIONS
It is appropriate first to note the use of the term actions in this context. In the past the term loads has
traditionally been used, and in fact it remains an entirely valid term in a Eurocode context. However, in
the Eurocodes the term loads is used to refer to a set of forces applied to a structure or the ground
(i.e. direct actions). The term action is used more generically to mean both loads and also imposed
deformations or accelerations, such as those due to thermal movements or earthquakes (i.e. indirect
actions). In many ways, the use of the term actions addresses an ambiguity in the way the term load
has been used in the past.
Actions are classified by their variation in time as either (see clause 4.1.1(1)P):
o
permanent actions (denoted G), e.g. self-weight of structures, road surfacing and indirect
actions such as uneven settlements;
variable actions (denoted Q), e.g. traffic load, wind and thermal actions; or,
It will be sensible for designers to become familiar with this terminology, rather than using the terms
dead and live load that may have been used in the past. Likewise, it will be advisable to reserve the
words persistent and transient for design situations. Referring to a transient load in a Eurocode
context is potentially rather confusing since it mixes the terminology for actions and design situations.
For permanent actions, EN 1990:2002,4.1.2(2)P explains that their characteristic value should either
be taken as a single value, Gk, or if the variability of G cannot be considered as small, as the worst
case of an upper value, Gk,sup, or a lower value, Gk,inf. Further guidance is provided on where the
variability can be considered to be small and specifically, EN 1990:2002, 4.1.2(5) states that the self
weight of the structure may be represented by a single value Gk based on mean density and nominal
dimensions.
In bridge design, important cases where the variability of G cannot be considered as small are loads
due to surfacing and ballast (see EN 1991-1-1:2002, 5.2.3). When the variability in G cannot be
considered as small, it is helpful to note that 4.1.2(2)P does not require upper and lower values of G
to be applied to the adverse and relieving areas of the influence surface. Rather, whichever single
value gives the worst case is taken throughout.
For variable actions, EN 1990:2002, 4.1.3 introduces another new concept for many bridge designers.
This is the concept of the four representative values of a variable action, and it is the third key
concept, as summarised in Section 2.9. As discussed later, these representative values are used in
the different combinations of actions.
The four representative values have different probabilities of occurrence. They are called the
characteristic, combination, frequent and quasi-permanent values. The characteristic value is the
main representative value, and is the value generally specified in the various parts of EN 1991. It is a
statistically extreme value: in the calibration of the basic highway traffic loading model, LM1, it is a
1000-year return period value (see EN 1991-2: 2003, Table 2.1); for wind and thermal actions it is
generally a 50-year return period value.
The combination value is established by EN 1990:2002 to address the reduced likelihood that
extreme values of more than one variable action will occur simultaneously. The frequent value of a
variable action can be understood as the value that is exceeded occasionally, but not too often
perhaps weekly or monthly. The calibration of the frequent value of LM1 is based on a one week
return period. The use of the word frequent here sometimes causes some confusion, since it is
essentially a relative term; here it is frequent in relation to the characteristic value. The quasipermanent value is generally the value that is exceeded most of the time. For traffic loads on bridges
and wind actions, the recommended quasi-permanent value is therefore zero.
24
The four representative values of a variable action are illustrated in Fig. 2.1. The combination,
frequent and quasi-permanent values of a variable action are found by multiplying the characteristic
value by 0, 1, and 2 respectively. For bridge design, recommended -factors are given in EN
1990:2002, A2.2. The UK National Annex modifies the values for road bridges and footbridges.
Instantaneous value of Q
Characteristic value Qk
t1
t2
t3
Time
Fig. 2.1. Illustration of four representative values of a variable action
25
Resistances:
partial factor for the action which takes account of the possibility of
unfavourable deviations of the action values from the representative
values
Sd
partial factor for the material property which takes account of the
possible unfavourable deviations of a material from its characteristic
value
Rd
f and f Sd into a single partial factor denoted F (or more specifically Q for variable actions
and G for permanent actions), and,
ii.
Values of F and M are given in the relevant Eurocode parts, and their National Annexes, with
material-behaviour independent factors (i.e. almost all partial factors on actions) given in EN
1990:2002, Annex A2. Clearly for linear analyses combining the partial factors in this way will not
affect the overall result. For non-linear analyses some careful thought is always required concerning
the correct application of partial factors (see e.g. EN 1992-2, 5.7).
26
27
permanent action. Cases can, however, be unavoidable in transient design situations, such as during
bridge launches or in balanced cantilever construction, see Fig. 2.2.
G,sup Gk,sup
G,inf Gk,inf
G,sup Gk,sup
In Case A, STR verification, single-source principle can be applied. EN1990 Set B partial
factors used.
2.
In Case B, EQU verification, single source principle not applied. EN1990 Set A partial factors
used.
Fig. 2.2. Illustration of partial factors used for STR and EQU verifications
28
ground are governing. An example would be the design of a prop to prevent overturning of the deck
during balanced cantilever construction. EN 1990:2002 effectively acknowledges this issue in Table
A2.4(A) Note 2, as discussed below.
Although such cases are rather rare, being effectively a special case of a special case, it is valuable to
provide some advice on how they should be treated. Firstly, it is clearly crucial (and a necessary part
of the EQU limit state) that the single source principle is not applied, i.e. that the favourable and
unfavourable parts of permanent actions from a single source are modelled and factored separately.
Secondly, applying either the partial factors for permanent actions in Tables A2.4(A) or (B) alone will
be not appropriate. The partial factors for permanent actions in Table A2.4(A) account for relative
uncertainty in their value and spatial distribution; whereas those partial factors for permanent actions
in Tables A2.4(B) reflect overall uncertainty in the magnitude of the action effect.
Generally, it will be appropriate to adopt an approach such as the following where minor variations in
the value or the spatial distribution of permanent actions from a single source are significant and the
strengths of construction materials are governing:
i.
model the favourable and unfavourable parts of permanent actions from a single source
separately
ii.
factor the (effects of) unfavourable parts of permanent actions by the product of G* and G,sup
as given in Table A2.4(A)
iii.
factor the (effects of) favourable parts of permanent actions by the product of G* and G,inf as
given in Table A2.4(A)
where G* is either G,sup or G,inf as given in Table A2.4(B), whichever is more onerous for the
particular verification.
The approach given in Note 2 in Table A2.4(A) is essentially similar to this approach, except that G*
is taken as approximately 1.3, rather than G,sup from Table A2,4(B), and no adjustment is made to the
value of G,inf from Table A2.4(B).
Where minor variations in the value or the spatial distribution of permanent actions from a single
source are significant and the strength of the ground is governing, it is likely to be appropriate to use a
similar approach to that suggested above and adjust the Table A2.4(B) and Table A2.4(C) partial
factors is a similar fashion, applying them in conjunction with the partial factors on materials and
resistances defined in EN 1997-1:2004, depending upon the Design Approach applied.
29
Three combinations of actions are used for ultimate limit state verifications: one is used for persistent
and transient design situations, one for accidental design situations and one for seismic design
situations.
Three combinations of actions are used for serviceability limit state verifications. These are called the
characteristic combination, the frequent combination and the quasi-permanent combination. The
quasi-permanent combination is also used for calculating long-term effects, such as creep. Although
not always wholly honoured by the other Eurocode parts, it was the intention of EN 1990:2002 that the
characteristic combination would generally be used for irreversible serviceability limit state
verifications and the less onerous frequent combination would be used for reversible serviceability
limit state verifications.
30
Accidental
design situations
6.11
1.0
1.0
Accompanying
variable actions,
Qk,j
(j > 1)
Persistent or
transient design
situations
Leading variable
action, Qk,1
Prestress, P
6.10
Ultimate
limit
states
Accidental action
Permanent actions,
Gk
(1)
EN 1990 Equ
(1)
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
n/a
1.0
Ad
1.0
or2
1.0
(3)
1
(4)
Serviceability
limit
(6)
states
Seismic design
situations
6.12
1.0
1.0
AEd
1.0
1.0
Characteristic
combination
6.14
1.0
1.0
n/a
1.0
1.0
1.0
Frequent
combination
6.15
1.0
1.0
n/a
1.0
1.0
Quasipermanent
(5)
combination
6.16
1.0
1.0
n/a
1.0
1.0
Notes:
(1) Values of are obtained from Tables A2.4(A)-(C)
(2) Values of are obtained from Tables A2.1, Table A2.2, Table A2.3 for road bridges, footbridges
and rail bridges respectively
(3) Either expressions 6.10 or the more onerous of 6.10a and 6.10b may be used (the decision is a
Nationally Determined Parameter). Expression 6.10 is used in this example.
(4) Expression 6.11 allows the use of either or 1 or 2. The decision is a Nationally Determined
Parameter, see Table A2.5. However, see also EN 1990:2002, A2.2.5(3).
(5) Also used for long term effects.
(6) Guidance on which combination should be used for specific serviceability limit state verifications
is given in the relevant parts of EN 1992 to EN 1999.
31
EFFECT
DESIGN RESISTANCE
STRUCTURE ANALYSIS
DESIGN ACTIONS
(i)
REPRESENTATIVE ACTIONS
Frep
CHARACTERISTIC ACTIONS
Fd
Fk
Rd
Ed
Xk
Xd
(ii)
(ii)
CALCULATION OF RESISTANCE
Sd
COMBINATIONS
DESIGN EFFECT
Actions
Ed<Rd
Material
Properties
Rd
RESISTANCE
Effects
of
Actions
ULS
(i)
Where the action is a traffic load group, factors will have been pre-applied to the
non-leading actions within that group
(ii)
In many cases, Sd may be combined with f and applied as a single factor F to the
actions, and Rd is combined with m and applied as a single factor M to the material
properties.
Figure 2.3. Verification of STR limit state for persistent or transient design situation
2.8 Conclusions
An overview of the key aspects of EN 1990:2002 relevant to bridge design has been presented. Six
key concepts have been identified that bridge designers should understand, viz:
i.
design situations;
ii.
iii.
iv.
v.
vi.
combinations of actions.
32
The first five concepts all play a key role in understanding the sixth concept. The category of design
situation dictates the combination of actions used for ultimate limit state verifications. The distinction
between reversible and irreversible serviceability limit states explains why both the characteristic and
frequent combinations of actions are used for serviceability limit state verifications. The four
representative values of variable actions play a key role in accounting for the reduced likelihood that
extreme values of several variable actions will occur at the same time and in the various combinations
of actions having different statistical likelihoods of occurring. The six ultimate limit states and the
single source principle dictate how partial factors are applied and the values used for persistent and
transient design situations.
The Eurocodes differentiate between reversible and irreversible serviceability limit states. Irreversible
serviceability limit states are of greater concern than reversible serviceability limit states. The
acceptable probability of an irreversible serviceability limit state being exceeded is lower than that for
a reversible serviceability limit state. A more onerous combination of actions is used for irreversible
serviceability limit states than reversible serviceability limit states.
There are four different representative values of a Variable Action. The characteristic value is a
statistically extreme value. It is the main representative value, and the value generally defined in
EN1991. The other representative values are called the combination value, frequent value and quasipermanent value. They are determined by multiplying the characteristic value by 0 , 1 and 2
respectively. The combination, frequent and quasi-permanent values are less statistically extreme
than the characteristic value, so 0 , 1 and 2 are always less than 1.
33
The Eurocodes explicitly establish six different ultimate limit states. Two of these, UPL and HYD, are
specific to EN1997. Two are concerned with resistances: STR when verifying structural resistance
and GEO when verifying the resistance of the ground. FAT is concerned with fatigue. EQU is
principally concerned with ultimate limit states involving a loss of overall equilibrium. However, it has
an important relationship with the single source principle (see key concept summary 5). Different
partial factors on actions and geotechnical material properties are used for different ultimate limit
states
Application of the single source principle allows a single partial factor to be applied to the whole of an
action arising from a single source. The value of the partial factor used depends on whether the
resulting action effect is favourable or unfavourable. EN1990 allows the single source principle to be
used for STR and GEO verifications. EQU addresses cases when minor variations in the magnitude
or spatial distribution of a permanent action from a single source are significant
EN1990 establishes six different combinations of actions relevant to bridge design. Different
combinations of actions are used for verifying different limit states. They have different statistical
likelihoods of occurring. The quasi-permanent combination is also used when analysing long-term
effects. The differences between the combinations of actions concern: whether partial factors are
applied; which representative values of variable actions are used; and, whether there is an accidental
or seismic action included. The different combinations of actions are used in conjunction with the
Eurocode material parts. The Eurocode part generally states explicitly which combination is to be
used in each SLS verification.
34
CHAPTER 3
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
36
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
3.1 Introduction
The scope of the following example is to present the wind actions and effects usually applied on a
bridge, to both deck and piers.
The following cases will be handled:
o
o
o
The aforementioned cases will be considered for two alternative pier dimensions:
o
o
Essentially, a wind action transversal to the deck (normal to its longitudinal axis) will be considered.
Additional indications will be given for wind action along the bridge deck and in the vertical direction.
Through the presentation of the example reference to the relevant EN Eurocodes Parts (essentially
EN 1991-1-4) will be given as appropriate and some comments, where necessary. In the following all
references to clauses of EN 1991-1-4 will be given within brackets in italics []. If the reference
concerns another EN Eurocode Part, then it will be noted, as well.
The wind actions on bridges are described in Section [8], with some cross references to other
clauses, where necessary. In [8.2] it is noted that an assessment should be made, whether a dynamic
response procedure is needed. This matter is left open for the NAs. It is also stated that normal
bridges with spans less than 40 m generally do not need dynamic calculations; some Member States
(MS) have adopted as limit span for this purpose 100 m.
In this example it is considered that there is no need for a dynamic response procedure.
Fw = cs cd c f q p ( z e ) Aref
Where:
cs cd
cf
is the force coefficient [8.3.1, 7.6 and 7.13, 7.9.2, respectively, for the deck, the rectangular
and the cylindrical pier]
qp(ze)
is the peak velocity pressure [4.5] at reference height ze, which is usually taken as the height
z above the ground of the C.G. of the structure subjected to the wind action
Aref
is the reference area of the structure [8.3.1, 7.6, 7.9.1, respectively, for the deck, the
rectangular and the cylindrical pier]
37
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
In the example considered, as no dynamic response procedure will be used, it may be assumed that
cs.cd = 1.0 [8.2(1)]. Otherwise [6.3] together with [Annex B or C] should be used to determine the
structural factor.
The peak velocity pressure qp(z) at height z, includes the mean and the short-term (turbulent)
fluctuations and is expressed by the formula [4.8]:
q p ( z ) = [1 + 7 I v ( z ) ]
1
2
v m ( z ) = c e ( z ) qb = c e ( z )
2
1
2
vb
where:
is the air density (which depends on the altitude, temperature and barometric pressure to be
expected in the region during wind storms; the recommended value, used in this example, is
3
1.25 kg/m
vm(z) is the mean wind velocity at a height z above the ground [4.3]
Iv(z)
is the turbulence intensity at height z, defined [4.4(1)] as the ratio of the standard deviation of
the turbulence divided be the mean velocity, and is expressed by the following formula [4.7]
Iv ( z) =
v
vm ( z )
kI
co ( z ) ln z( / z0 )
I v ( z ) = I v ( zmin )
for
zmin z zmax
for
z < zmin
where:
kI
is the turbulence factor (NDP value). The recommended value, used in the example, is 1.0
z0
The peak velocity pressure may also be expressed as a product of the exposure factor ce (z) and the
basic velocity pressure qb [Eq. 4.10]. Charts of ce (z) may be drawn as a function of the terrain
category and the oreography, such as [Fig. 4.2] for co = 1.0 (flat terrain, [4.3.3]).
The mean wind velocity is expressed by the formula [4.3]:
vm (z)= cr (z) co (z) vb
where:
cr(z)
z
c ( z ) = k ln
r
r
z
0
)
c ( z) = c ( z
r
r min
for
z min z z max
for
z min z z max
where:
z0 is the roughness length [Table 4.1]
kr terrain factor depending on the roughness length and evaluated according the following formula
[4.5]:
38
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
kr
z
= 0.19 0
z
0, II
0.07
with:
z0,II
zmin
zmax
is to be taken as 200 m
z0, zmin depend on the terrain category; recommended values are given in [Table 4.1]
It is to note, by comparing the formulas [4.8] and [4.3], that the following expression may be deduced
for ce (z):
ce (z) = [1 + 7.Iv(z)] cr2 (z) co2(z)
vb,0
is the fundamental value of the basic wind velocity, defined as the characteristic 10 minutes
mean wind velocity (irrespective of wind direction and season of the year) at 10 m above
ground level in open country with low vegetation and few isolated obstacles (distant at least 20
obstacle heights)
cdir
is the directional factor, which may be an NDP; the recommended value is 1.0
cseason is the season factor, which may be an NDP; the recommended value is 1.0
In addition to that a probability factor cprob should be used, in cases where the return period for the
design defers from T = 50 years. This is usually the case, when the construction phase is considered.
Quite often also for bridges T = 100 is considered as the duration of the design life, which should lead
to cprob > 1.0. The expression of cprob is given in the following formula [4.2], in which the values of K
and n are NDPs; the recommended values are 0.2 and 0.5, respectively:
c prob
1 - K ln(- ln(1 - p ))
=
1 - K ln(- ln(0.98))
To resume:
To determine the wind actions on bridge decks and piers, it seems convenient to follow successively
the following steps:
o
o
o
o
Determine vb (by choosing vb,0, cdir,cseason and cprob, if relevant); qb may also be determined at
this stage.
Determine vm (z) (by choosing terrain category and reference height z to evaluate cr (z) and
co(z)).
Determine qp(z) (either by choosing directly ce(z), where possible, either by evaluating Iv(z),
after choosing co(z)).
Determine Fw (after evaluating Aref and by choosing cf and cscd, if relevant).
39
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
c prob
0.5
= (1.92 / 1.78)
0.5
1.08
0.5
1.04
This value (cprob = 1.04) will be further used in this example. (Note : The relevant presentation during
the Workshop has been based on cprob = 1.0). Thus :
vb = (cprob) cdir cseasonvb,0 = 1.04 x 1.0 x 1.0 x 26 = 27 m/s
The corresponding (basic velocity) pressure may also be computed, according to [Eq. 4.10]:
2
Squat pier, z = 10 m
For terrain category II, z0 = 0.05 and zmin = 2 m < 10 m = z [Table 4.1], thus:
0.05
k r = 0.19
0.05
0.07
= 0.19
and
r
0.05
As far as the oreography factor co(z) is concerned, due to the flat valley it is considered that co(10) =
1.0. In fact, in the general case where the ground level beneath the bridge is lower than the
surrounding ground the co < 1.0. Therefore the peak wind velocity is:
vm (10) = 1.0 x 1.0 x 27 = 27 m/s
The turbulence intensity is:
40
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
I v (10) =
1.0
1.0 ln(10 / 0.05)
1
5.298
= 0.189
and
1
q p (10) = [ (1 + 7 0.189) ] 1.25 27 2 = 2.32 455.6 = 1057 = ce (10) 455.6 in N/m2
2
Hence
ce(10) = 2.32
In this specific case the same result could be obtained by making use of [Fig. 4.2], because co(10) =
1.0.
Further calculations are needed to determine the wind force on the deck [5.3].
Both the force coefficient cf and the reference area Aref of the bridge deck [8.3.1] depend on the width
to (total) depth ratio b/dtot of the deck, where dtot represents the depth of the parts of the deck which
are considered to be subjected to the wind pressure.
In the case of the bridge in service, without consideration of the traffic, according to [8.3.1(4) and
Table 8.1], dtot is the sum of the projected (windward) depth of the structure, including the projecting
solid parts, such as footway or safety barrier base, plus 0.3m for the open safety barrier used in the
present example, in each side of the deck (see also Fig. 1.10 and drawings (Fig.1.11) of the cross
section). Consequently:
dtot = 2.800 + 0.400 0.025 x 2.500 + 0.200 + 2 x 0.300 = 3.1375 + 0.200 + 0.600 =
= 3.9375 4.00 m
The depth (height) of the concrete support of the safety barrier has been taken into account, since
0.200 > 0.025 x 3.500 + 0.030 + 0.080 = 0.0875 + 0.110 = 0.1975 m ( projection of the remaining
slope of the deck to the center line, waterproofing layer, asphalt layer).
Hence:
b/dtot = 12.00 / 4.00 = 3 (12.00 / 3.94 3.05)
Aref = dtot . L = 4.00 x 200.00 = 800.00 m
Fw = 1 / 2 vb C Aref , x
2
Where C = ce . cf,x is given in [Tab. 8.2] depending on b/dtot and ze . In our case one would get (by
interpolation) the value: (3.0-0.5) / (4.0-0.5) = (6.7-C)/(6.7-3.6) 2.5/3.5 = (6.7-C)/3.1 C = 6.7
3.1x2.5/3.5 = 4.4857 4.49 4.5, to be compared with the exact value C= ce . cf,x = 2.32 x 1.55 =
3.596 3.6. Using the interpolated value of C one gets:
41
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
High pier, z = 40 m
For terrain category II, z0 = 0.05 and zmin = 2 m < 40 m = z [Table 4.1], thus:
0.05
k r = 0.19
0.05
0.07
= 0.19
and
r
0.05
co(40) = 1.0 .
Hence:
vm (40) = 1.27 x 1.0 x 27 = 34.3 m/s
The turbulence intensity is:
I v (40) =
1.0
1.0 ln(40 / 0.05)
1
6.6846
= 0.15
And
1
q p (40) = [ (1 + 7 0.15) ] 1.25 34.32 = 2.05 734.9 = 1506.5
2
in N/m
Hence
2
Hence:
42
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
The magnitude which is differentiated, compared to the case without traffic, is the reference depth dtot
of exposure on wind action transversally to the deck. In that case:
dtot = 3.1375 + 0.200 + 2.0 = 5.3375 5.34 m
and
b/dtot = 12.00/5.34 = 2.25, cfx = cfx,0 1.83 and Aref = 5.34 x 200.00 = 1068 m
Hence:
High pier, z = 40 m
Again, the magnitude which is differentiated, compared to the case without traffic, is dtot which has the
value previously computed, i.e. dtot 5,34 m
and hence:
b/dtot = 2,25, cfx = cfx,0 1,83 and Aref = 1068 m
Finally:
(MOST
CRITICAL
CASE
AND
In practice the construction of the deck of a bridge similar to the bridge used in the present example
has a duration of few months. In particular the launching phase is planned to last some hours, not
even days, and is not getting started in case adverse weather conditions (wind etc.) are foreseen.
This explains the relevant assumption made for the wind velocity (see Chapter 1 , 1.4.4.3). So, it has
been agreed to use for the present example the value of vb= 50 km/h, i.e.in m/s vb= 50/3.6 = 13.89
14 m/s.
More generally, given that the construction phase has a limited duration and subsequently the
associated return period of the actions considered is lesser than the service design life of the
structure, cprob may be modified accordingly. In several cases this might also be the case for cseason for
a time period up to 3 months [EN 1991-1-6, Table 3.1]. In the same table the return periods for (up to)
3 months and (up to) 1 year are given, respectively T = 5 and 10 years. Therefore, the corresponding
probabilities for the exceedance of the extreme event once, are p = 1/5 = 0.20 and 1/10 = 0.10,
respectively. In the specific case of this example one might reasonably assume 3 months for the
43
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
duration of the construction, before casting the concrete slab, leading to cprob = 0.85. Nevertheless, a
more conservative approach would be to assume virtual delays, thus leading to a value of cprob = 0.9,
as it may be seen below:
c prob
0.5
= (1.45/1.78)
0.5
0.5
= 0.8146
= 0.902 0.9
It is rather evident that the termination of the construction phases, following the casting of the
concrete slab and its hardening, is not a critical design situation by itself. Still, it will be included in the
example, so that it can be combined with other relevant actions, after termination of the pushing of the
steel structure and before starting the concrete casting. During detailed design the various
construction phases should be considered and verified individually. In this example the situation,
where the steel structure launched (without addition of a nose-girder) from one side (abutment C0) is
about to reach as cantilever the pier P2, will be considered as representative of design situations
critical for the dimensioning of key steel structural elements. In that specific the length of the bridge to
be taken into account is L= 60.00 + 80.00 = 140.00 m and dtot = 2. dmain beam = 2 x 2.80 = 5.60 m.
Hence:
Aref = 5.60 x 140.00 = 784.00 m
And
b/dtot = 12.00/5.60 = 2.14, cfx = cfx,0 1.9
Squat pier, z = 10 m
1
q p (10) = [1 + 7 0.189) ] 1.25 142 = 2.32 122.5 = 284.2
2
in N/m
Finally:
Fw =1.01.9284.21120.00=539.981120.00=604777.6 N 605 kN
Or wind load in the transverse (x-direction) remains, of course, unchanged:
w 605 / 200 3 kN/m
High pier, z = 40 m
1
q p (40) = [ (1 + 7 0.15) ] 1.25 182 = 2.05 202.5 = 415.125 415 in N/m2
2
44
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Finally:
Service life
with traffic
Construction phase
(steel alone
end of pushing)
Construction phase
(steel alone cantilever at P2)
z = ze (m)
10
40
10
40
10
40
10
40
vb,0 (m/s)
26
26
26
26
vb (m/s)
27
27
27
27
14
14
14
14
vm (m/s)
27
34.3
27
34.3
14
18
14
18
455.6
455.6
455.6
455.6
122.5
122.5
122.5
122.5
455.6
734.9
455.6
734.9
122.5
202.5
122.5
202.5
qp (N/m )
1057
1506.5
1057
1506.5
284.2
415
284.2
415
ce
2.32
3.30
2.32
3.30
2.32
3.30
2.32
3.30
dtot (m)
4.00
4.00
5.34
5.34
5.60
5.60
5.60
5.60
L (m)
200
200
200
200
140
140
140
140
Aref,x (m )
800
800
1068
1068
1120
1120
784
784
b/dtot
3.00
3.00
2.25
2.25
2.14
2.14
2.14
2.14
cf,x
1.55
1.55
1.83
1.83
1.9
1.9
1.9
1.9
Fw (kN)
1312
1868
2066
2944
605
883
423
618
w (kN/m)
6.55
9.34
10.33
14.72
4.4
4.4
qb (N/m )
qm (N/m )
Using the values of w (kN/m) summarized in the table one can get the resulting wind forces acting on
the supports of the deck. The deck may be considered as a three span continuous beam at service
life (without and with traffic) and a single span one-sided cantilevered beam during construction (one
case examined).
45
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
bridges vertical wind forces are almost an order of magnitude less than the self weight and the
permanent loads.
, q p ( ze ), Aref .
In this case cs cd = 1.0 and cf are given by the following formula [7.9]:
cf = cf,0 r
Where:
cf,0
is the force coefficient of rectangular sections with sharp corners and without free-end flow [Fig.
7.23]
46
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
m one should use the following values of qp along the height of the pier:
o
o
o
Due to the limited influence of the wind action for a squat not very high pier, a unique value will be
2
considered, qp (10) = 1057 N/ m
Finally: Fw =1.01.14105725.00=120525.00=30125 N 30 kN
is the force coefficient of circular sections (finite cylinders) without free-end flow [Fig. 7.28]
For the use of [Fig. 7.28] the Reynolds number [Eq. 7.15] based on the peak wind velocity according
to [4.5, Eq. 4.8] and the equivalent surface roughness k [Tab. 7.13] need first to be computed.
The combination of formulas [7.15] and [4.8] leads to the following expression:
v (ze)= vm (ze) {1 +7 Iv (ze)}
0.5
0.5
This value is a bit further than the limiting value of [Fig. 7.28].
The equivalent roughness is 0.2 mm for smooth and 1,0 mm for rough concrete. Smooth concrete
-5
surface will be assumed. This leads to k/b = 0.2/4000 = 5 x 10 . From Fig 7.28 a value greater than
0.7 is expected. By using the relevant formula one gets:
6
47
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
48
h2
h1
T1 -8C
T1 = 10C
T1 = -10C
T2 +4C
T1 +16C
h1
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
0
h1 = 0.6 h
h 2 = 0.4 m
T2 -15C
49
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
3.6 Introduction
Aim of the present note is to illustrate the application of Eurocode Parts concerning Actions during
execution (EN1991-1-6), Accidental actions (EN1991-1-7) and Traffic loads on bridges (EN1991-2),
with special reference to the design of a three span continuous steel-concrete composite two girders
bridge, which has been chosen as relevant reference case study (see Chapter 1 Crespo and
Davaine).
launching phase;
50
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
ca
Personnel and hand tools (working personnel, staff and visitors with hand tools or other
small site equipment)
cb
cc
cd
Movable heavy machinery and equipment (cranes, lifts, vehicles, power installations,
jacks, heavy lifting devices and trucks)
ce
cf
Loads from part of structure in a temporary state or loads from lifting operations
Construction load Qcb is represented by a uniformly distributed load qcb and a concentrated load Fcb.
2
For bridges, the minimum recommended values are qcb,k=0.2 kN/m and Fcb,k=100 kN.
Unless more accurately specified, construction loads Qcc are represented by a uniformly distributed
2
load qcc; the minimum recommended value is qcc,k=0.5 kN/m .
When loads Qcd are not defined in project specification, information about their definition may be
found in the relevant ENs: for example, in EN1991-2 for vehicles or in EN1991-3 for cranes and
machinery.
Loads Qce due to accumulation of waste materials may vary significantly, and over short time periods,
depending on types of materials, climatic conditions, build-up and clearance rates, and they can also
induce possible mass effects on horizontal, inclined and vertical elements (such as walls).
Finally, loads Qcf should be taken into account and modeled according to the planned execution
sequences and their consequences, like load reversals and/or variation of the static scheme.
Construction loads Qc may be represented in the appropriate design situations (see EN 1990), either,
as one single variable action, or where relevant by a group of different types of construction loads,
which is applied as a single variable action. Single and/or a grouping of construction loads should be
considered to act simultaneously with Non construction loads as appropriate.
During the casting of the concrete slab, working personnel (Qca), formwork and load-bearing members
(Qcc) and weight of the fresh concrete, which is classified as Qcf, should be considered acting
simultaneously. According to EN 1991-1-7 recommendations, during the concrete casting of the deck,
in the actual area it can be identified two parts, the working area, which is a square whose side is the
minimum between 3.0 m and the span length, and the remaining (outside the working area).
The actual area is loaded by the self-weight of the formwork and load bearing element Qcc and by the
2
weight of the fresh concrete Qcf (about 7.5 kN/m in the example), the working area by 0.10 Qcf, with
2
2
2
the restriction 0.75 kN/m 0.10 Qcf1.5 kN/m (0.75 kN/m ), and the area outside the working area by
2
0.75 kN/m , covering Qca.
In the example, two different load cases could be envisaged in principle, as shown in Fig. 3.3 and 3.4,
to maximize effects on the slab cross sections on the support and on the midspan, respectively; in
51
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
effect they are coincident, as loads inside and outside the working area are, in the current case,
exactly the same.
9500
2500
working area
1500
2800
actual area
7000
12000
Fig. 3.3 Load arrangement maximizing effects on the support cross section of the slab
4500
3000
working area
4500
1500
2800
7000
12000
Fig. 3.4 Load arrangement maximizing effects on the midspan of the slab
52
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
150,00 m
C0
P1
P2
60,00 m
C3
80,00 m
60,00 m
STR
Counterweight?
EQU
P1
P2
WEB
18 x 40000
LOWER FLANGE
Constant width 1200
35000 x 40
8000
x
80
10000
x
55
28000 x 40
26 x 36000
10000
x
55
8000
x
80
10000
x
55
8000
x
80
18000 x 120
10000
x
80
5000
x
55
10000
x
80
5000
x
55
26 x 36000
18 x48000
18000 x 120
2720
2640
18000 x 120
28000 x 40
2560
10000
x
80
10000
x
55
2640
5000
x
55
8000
x
80
60,00 m
2690
18000 x 120
2720
10000
x
80
2690
5000
x
55
2640
2560
35000 x 40
C3
80,00 m
2640
UPPER FLANGE
Constant width 1000
2690
2720
2800
60,00 m
2690
C0
35000 x 40
18 x 40000
35000 x 40
G,suo=1.05 and
Q=1.35, as the construction phase is a transient design situation;
the design value of the stabilizing loads is
G,inf G k,inf ,
53
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
being G,inf=0.95.
The destabilizing design effect is then given by
G,sup=1.35 and Q=1.50. For example, the design bending moment at the support P1 is
Ffr ,d ,min = 0 and Ffr , d ,max = 0.04 (1.35 377.3 + 1.5 490.4 ) = 49.8 kN
Once reached the pier P1, the launch can go on (Fig. 3.7) for maximum 60.0 m more and afterward,
the remaining part of the beam can be joined and the final phase of the launch can be take place.
During this final phase, when the free end of the beam is near the pier P2, the span of the
cantilevered part is maximum (see Fig. 3.7) and the design bending moment at the support P1 is:
54
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
C0
50,00 m
150,00 m
C0
60,00 m
80,00 m
60,00 m
30,00 m
C3
P2
P1
C3
P2
P1
150,00 m
60,00 m
50,00 m
80,00 m
60,00 m
STR
vertical temperature difference between bottom and upper part of the beam;
also giving information about the control of accidental loads, since in many cases structural measures
alone cannot be considered as sufficient.
The load models given in the main text of EN1991-1-7 are rather conventional, while more advanced
models are presented in Annex C of EN1991-1-7 itself.
55
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
In the following short reference will be made to collisions due to trucks on road bridges, being the
other topics outside of the scope of the present note.
Type of vehicle
Motorway
Country road
Urban area
Courtyards/garages
Courtyards/garages
Truck
Truck
Truck
Passengers cars only
Trucks
1000
750
500
50
150
500
375
250
25
75
More advanced probabilistic models as well as more refined models for dynamic and non-linear
analyses are provided in informative Annexes of EN1991-1-7.
56
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Table 3.4 Indicative equivalent static design forces due to impact on superstructures.
Category of traffic
500
375
250
75
Excluding future re-surfacing of the roadway under the bridge, the recommended value for adequate
clearance h to avoid impact is in the range 5.0 m to 6.0 m (Fig. 3.8). When the clearance is h 5.0 m,
impact forces can be derived again from Table 3.4, when the clearance is h 6.0 m, impact forces
can be set to zero, resorting to linear interpolation when h ranges between 5.0 m and 6.0 m.
The same impact forces as given in Table 3.4 are also considered on the underside surfaces of
bridge decks with an upward inclination angle of 10 (see Fig. 3.8).
F(h')
F(h)
F(h)
10
10
driving
h
h'
h
drivig
direction
direction
57
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Number of notional
lanes nl
Width of a notional
lane
Width of the
remaining area
W < 5.4 m
3m
w-3 m
5.4 m w< 6 m
0.5 w
6mw
int(w/3)
3m
w-3nl
The carriageway is defined as the part of the roadway surface sustained by a single structure (deck,
pier etc.).
The carriageway includes all the physical lanes (marked on the roadway surface), the hard shoulders,
the hard strips and the marker strips. The carriageway width w should be measured between the
kerbs, if their height is greater than 100 mm (recommend value), or between the inner limits of the
safety barriers, in all other cases.
The number and the positions of the notional lanes depend on the element under consideration and
should be chosen each time in order to maximize the considered effect. In general, the notional lane
that gives the most severe effect is numbered lane n. 1 and so on, in decreasing order of severity. For
this reason, the locations of the notional lanes are not linked with their numbering, nor with the
position of physical lanes (see Fig. 3.9, for example).
In particular cases, for example for some serviceability limit states or for fatigue verifications, it is
possible to derogate from this rule and to consider less severe locations of the notional lanes, as it will
be shown in the following.
Remaining area
3.0
Notional lane n. 1
Remaining area
3.0
Notional lane n. 2
Remaining area
3.0
Notional lane n. 3
Remaining area
58
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Load model n. 1 (LM1) generally reproduces traffic effects to be taken into account for global
and local verifications; it is composed by concentrated and uniformly distributed loads: a
system of two concentrated axle loads, one per notional lane i, representing a tandem system
weighing 2QiQki (see Table 3.6), whose geometry is shown diagrammatically in Fig. 3.10,
and by a system of uniformly distributed loads having a weight density per square meter of
qiqki. The adjustment factors Qi and qi depend on the class of the route and on the
expected traffic type: in absence of specific indications, they are assumed equal to 1, as in the
present example.
Table 3.6 Load model n. 1 characteristic values
Position
Notional lane n. 1
300
9.0
Notional lane n. 2
200
2.5
Notional lane n. 3
100
2.5
2.5
Remaining area
2.5
0.6
0.4
0.4
Load model n. 2 (LM2) reproduces traffic effects on short structural members. The local load
model n. 2, LM2 (Fig. 3.11), consists of a single axle load QQak on specific rectangular tire
contact areas, 0.350.6 m, being Qak=400 kN, dynamic amplification included. Unless
otherwise specified Q=Q1. LM2, which is intended only for local verifications, should be
considered alone on the bridge, travelling in the direction of the longitudinal axis of the bridge,
in the most unfavourable position. When unfavourable, only one wheel should be considered.
0.4
0.8
0.6
Longitudinal axis
of the bridge
0.4
1.6
Longitudinal axis
of the bridge
1.4
1.2
0.4
0.35
0.4
59
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Load model n. 3 (LM3), special vehicles, should be considered only when requested, in a
transient design situation. It represents abnormal vehicles not complying with national
regulations on weight and dimension of vehicles. The geometry and the axle loads of the
special vehicles to be considered in the bridge design should be assigned by the bridge
owner. Additional information can be found in Annex A of EN 1991-2.
Load model n. 4 (LM4), a crowd loading, is particularly significant for bridges situated in urban
areas. It should be applied on all the relevant parts of the length and width of the bridge deck,
including the central reservation, if necessary. Anyhow, it should be considered only when
expressly required. The nominal value of the load, including dynamic amplification, is equal to
5.0 kN/m2, while the combination value is reduced to 3.0 kN/m2.
Q tk =40
Qv
[kN], if 200 m r 1500 m; Q tk =0 , if r >1500 m.
r
60
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
like for bridges in urban or industrial areas, a value of 2 other than zero may be envisaged for the
UDL system of LM1 only.
Table 3.7 Characteristic values of multicomponent actions for traffic loads on road bridges
Footways and
cycle tracks
Carriageway
Vertical loads
Group of
loads
Main load
model
Characteristic
values
Frequent
values
Horizontal loads
Special
vehicles
Crowd
loading
Braking force
Vertical loads
only
Centrifugal
force
Combination
value
Characteristic Characteristic
values
values
Characteristic
values
4
5
Uniformly
distributed
Characteristic
values
see Annex A
of EN1991-2
Characteristic
values
Characteristic
values
Table 3.8 Recommended values of - factors for traffic loads on road bridges
1infq
0.75
0.40
0.80
0.80
0.75
0.40
0
0
0.80
0.75
Traffic loads
(see table 6)
0.80
0.80
0.75
1.0
Action
Symbol
gr1a (LM1)
Tandem System
UDL
61
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Leading action,
accompanying
gr1a
(1,35 Gkj,sup
j 1
1,35 gr1b
1,35 gr2 + 1,5 0,6 Tk
or 1,00 Gkj,inf ) "+" (1,00 or 0 ) S " +" 1,35 (gr3 or gr4 ) + 1,5 0,6 Tk
1,35 gr5
1,5FWk
0gr1a
1,5Q
Sn,k
where S represents the settlements, TS and UDL indicate the tandem system and the uniformly
*
distributed load of the LM1, respectively, q fk the combination value of the crowd loading, QSn,k the
*
snow load, FW,k the wind force, F W the upper limit of the wind force compatible with normal traffic, and
Tk the thermal action.
It is important to recall that partial factor Q for unfavourable effects of traffic actions on road bridges is
1.35.
3.9.3.2 Characteristic, frequent and quasi-permanent combinations of traffic actions
With the same meaning of the symbols, the combinations of actions to be considered for SLS
verifications can be easily written. So the characteristic combinations of actions become
Leading action,
accompanying
gr1a
(Gkj,sup
j 1
gr1b
gr2 + 0,6 Tk
FWk
0gr1a
Q
Sn,k
62
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Leading action,
accompanying
1gr1a
(Gkj,sup
j 1
0,75 gr1b
0,4 gr3 + 0,5 Tk
or Gkj,inf ) "+" (1,00 or 0 ) S "+"
0,75 gr4 + 0,5 Tk
0,2 FWk
0,6 Tk
Modelled girder
2,00
2,00
Girder no. 1
Axle of the bridge
Girder no. 2
3,50
3,50
Fig. 3.12 Location of physical lanes and hard shoulders on the carriageway
63
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
0,50
1,00
3,00
3,00
Lane 1
3,00
Lane 2
Girder no. 1
2,00
Remaining
Lane 3
Girder no. 2
3,50
3,50
64
0.2143
0.6429
1.0714
1
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Modelled girder
0,50
1,00
3,00
3,00
Lane 1
3,00
Lane 2
Lane 3
Girder no. 1
Axle of the bridge
Girder no. 2
3,50
3,50
Fig. 3.14 Notional lanes arrangement for global verifications of the main girders
The values of braking and acceleration forces for the most significant longitudinal traffic load
arrangements are reported in Figure 3.15.
65
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
C0
C0
L=200 m
Qlk=900 kN
60,00 m
80,00 m
60,00 m
C3
P2
P1
P1
C3
P2
60,00 m
C0
L=60 m
Qlk=522 kN
P2
P1
C3
80,00 m
C0
L=80 m
Qlk=577 kN
60,00 m
60,00 m
C0
P1
60,00 m
C3
P2
P1
P2
80,00 m
L=120 m
Qlk=685 kN
C3
L=140 m
Qlk=739 kN
Fig. 3.15 Calculation of braking and acceleration forces in various load cases
o
Detailed discussion of the fatigue load models is outside the scope of the present note and only
fatigue load model n. 3 will be considered in the following 3.9.4.1.
It is only necessary to stress that fatigue load models n. 2 and n. 4 are the most refined ones and they
are load spectra constituted by five standardised vehicles, representative of the most common
European lorries, while fatigue load 1 is extremely simple and very safe-sided.
Fatigue load model n. 2, is a set of lorries with frequent values of axle loads, and fatigue model n. 4 is
a set of lorries with equivalent values of the axle loads, are illustrated in Tables 3.2 and 3.3,
respectively. They allow to perform very precise and sophisticated verifications, provided that the
interactions amongst vehicles simultaneously crossing the bridge are negligible or opportunely
considered.
66
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Fatigue load model n. 2 derives from the main load model used for assessing static resistance: the
load values are simply reduced to frequent ones, multiplying the axle loads Qik of the tandem system
by 0.7 and the weight density of the uniformly distributed loads qik by 0.3.
Obviously, beside the conventional models, EN 1991-2 allows also the use of real traffic data (fatigue
load model n. 5, which is the most accurate one), provided that the recorded traffic is representative of
the expected traffic on the bridge.
In conclusion, from the above consideration, the number of fatigue load models provided in 4.6 of
EN1991-2 it is not surprising, as they answer to different design demands.
3.9.4.1 Fatigue load model n. 3
The simplified fatigue load model n. 3, conceived for damage computations, is constituted by a
symmetrical conventional four axle vehicle, also said fatigue vehicle (Fig. 3.16). The equivalent load of
each axle is 120 kN. This model is accurate enough for spans bigger than 10 m, while for smaller
spans it results generally safe-sided.
6.0
67
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
support
midspan
x=35 m
x=72 m
Fig. 3.17 Cross sections considered for fatigue assessment
o
annual traffic flow of lorries per slow lane set to 0.5106, considering a road with medium flow
of lorries according to EN1991-2 (table 4.5);
according to table 3.1 of EN1993-1-9, a partial factor for fatigue strength MF=1.15 has been
adopted, considering damage tolerant details and high consequences of fatigue failure;
stress cycles have been identified using the reservoir counting method, or, equivalently, the
rainflow method;
D = i
ni
1 , where ni
Ni
is the actual number of cycles at the stress range MF i and Ni the characteristic fatigue
strength at MF i.
3.9.5.1 Classification of steel fatigue details
Steel details have been classified according to tables 8.1 to 8.4 of EN 1993-1-9, as follows.
In the cross section x=35, full penetration transverse butt welds of upper and lower flange have been
identified as class 11 details of table 8.3 of EN1993-1-9 (see Fig. 3.18.a), considering the tapered
zone far from the weld. The basic classification of this detail is 80 MPa, but, as the plate thickness is
40 mm, the effective detail class results
0.2
c ,ef
25
= ks c = 80 = 0.91 80 = 72.8 MPa .
40
The basic upper flange detail of the other three cross sections can be classified as 80 MPa, due to the
presence of welded studs, according to detail 9 of table 8.4 of EN1993-1-9 (see Fig. 3.18.b).
68
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Finally, the basic lower flange detail of the other three cross sections can be classified as 100 MPa,
according to detail 7 of table 8.2 of EN1993-1-9 (see Fig. 3.18.c).
The characteristic S-N curves of the above mentioned details are finally illustrated in Fig. 3.19.
- C=80 MPa
- C,ef=72.8 MPa
[MPa]
400
320
280
240
m
=3
200
180
160
140
0
10
120
100
80
.8
72
80
70
60
50
m=
5
40
30
20 4
10
10
10
10
69
10
10
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
S-N curve n.
N*
k1
k2
2
4
7
106
107
107
5
3
3
9
5
5
(N*)
[MPa]
162.5
58.5
35
106
185
106 5
10
5
6
106
106
Steel reinforcement
Straight bars
Welded bars and meshes
Jointing devices
Prestressing steel
Pre-tensioning
Post tensioning
single strands in plastic ducts
5
5
3
185
10
150
7
5
120
80
[MPa]
400
320
280
k1=5
240
200
180
160
A
162.5
140
k2=9
120
100
k1=3
80
70
60
58.5
50
40
k2=5
30
20 4
10
10
10
10
10
70
10
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
-6
-4
-2
0
2
M1
4
6
M2
8
10
12
0
50
100
x [m]
150
200
Fig. 3.21 Influence line and stress history induced by LM3 (cross section x=35 m, =1)
-8
-7
-6
-5
-4
-3
-2
M2
-1
0
M1
1
2
0
50
100
150
200
x [m]
Fig. 3.22 Influence line and stress history induced by LM3 (cross section x=60 m, =1)
71
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
-6
-4
-2
0
2
M1
M2
6
8
0
50
100
150
200
x [m]
Fig. 3.23 Influence line and stress history induced by LM3 (cross section x=72 m, =1)
-4
-2
0
2
4
6
M1
8
10
12
14
0
50
100
150
M2
200
x [m]
Fig. 3.24 Influence line and stress history induced by LM3 (cross section x=100 m, =1)
3.9.5.4 Notional lanes arrangements for fatigue assessment
Strictly speaking, the notional lanes arrangement for fatigue assessment should be determined using
the same criteria just indicated for static verifications, but this methodology could result too much
safe-sided, as it will be shown below, so that more realistic assumption are to be adopted. This is not
contradictory with EN1991-2, as it states that, in some cases, it is possible to consider less severe
lane arrangements for fatigue or SLS verifications.
In the present example, influence coefficients 1=1.0714 for the first lane and 2=0.6429 for the
second lane correspond to the most severe notional lanes arrangement (see Fig. 3.25), which will be
indicated as case 1 in the following. Nevertheless, this lane arrangement appears clearly unrealistic
for fatigue assessment purposes.
72
0.6429
1.0714
1
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Modelled girder
0,50
1,50
2,50
2,00
2,00
3,00
3,00
Girder no. 1
Axle of the bridge
Girder no. 2
Case 1
3,50
3,50
Fig. 3.25 Most severe notional lanes arrangement for fatigue (unrealistic)
0.2857
0.7857
Consequently, more realistic notional lanes arrangements can be envisaged, like the one shown in
Fig. 3.26, where the borders of the notional lanes corresponds to the borders of the physical lanes. In
this case, case 2, influence coefficients become 1=0.7857 and 2=0.2857, for the first and the
second lane, respectively
Modelled girder
2,00
1,50
2,00
3,00
2,00
3,00
Girder no. 1
Axle of the bridge
Girder no. 2
Case 2
3,50
3,50
73
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Case 2
Mf M1 [kNm]
8400.5
6160.4
Mf M2 [kNm]
5040.3
2240.1
Mf M3 [kNm]
507.9
372.5
Mf M4 [kNm]
304.7
135.4
D (upper flange)
0.00E+00 0.00E+00
D (lower flange)
3.52E+00 7.47E-01
D (straight rebar)
1.06E-09 6.44E-11
D (welded rebar)
1.04E-03 2.06E-04
Case 2
Mf M1 [kNm]
5030.3
3688.9
Mf M2 [kNm]
3018.2
1341.4
Mf M3 [kNm]
2166.9
1589.0
Mf M4 [kNm]
1300.1
577.8
D (upper flange)
0.00E+00 0.00E+00
D (lower flange)
0.00E+00 0.00E+00
D (straight rebar)
2.90E-08 1.76E-09
D (welded rebar)
6.64E-03 1.32E-03
Case 2
Mf M1 [kNm]
5207.7
3819.0
Mf M2 [kNm]
3124.6
1388.7
Mf M3 [kNm]
953.8
699.5
572.3
254.4
Mf M4 [kNm]
D (upper flange)
0.00E+00 0.00E+00
D (lower flange)
0.00E+00 0.00E+00
D (straight rebar)
2.96E-12 1.80E-13
D (welded rebar)
3.97E-05 7.87E-06
74
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
Case 2
Mf M1 [kNm]
6936.0
5086.4
Mf M2 [kNm]
4161.6
1849.6
Mf M3 [kNm]
1037.8
761.1
Mf M4 [kNm]
622.7
276.7
D (upper flange)
0.00E+00 0.00E+00
D (lower flange)
0.00E+00 0.00E+00
D (straight rebar)
1.89E-10 1.15E-11
D (welded rebar)
4.00E-04 7.92E-05
As anticipated, it must be stressed that notional lanes arrangement considered in case 1 is much
more severe than notional lane arrangement considered in case 2. For example, in the cross section
x=35 m the fatigue check of lower flange detail fails considering case 1 and the fatigue damage
results about five times higher than those obtained considering case 2.
Finally, it is necessary to recall that, in principle, the achievement of a fatigue damage D=0 for
structural steel details it is not sufficient by itself to conclude that fatigue check is satisfactory, if
equivalent fatigue load models are used, as in the current case.
In fact, by definition, equivalent fatigue models are not able to reproduce the maximum stress ranges
which are significant for fatigue, which should be compared with the constant amplitude fatigue limit.
For the latter purpose, it is necessary to use frequent fatigue load models.
75
Chapter 3: Actions on bridge decks and piers (EN 1991) N. Malakatas, P. Croce
REFERENCES
CEN 2002. Eurocode: Basis of structural design. EN 1990: 2002. European Committee for
Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2005. Eurocode 1 - Actions on structures. Part 1-6: General actions. Actions during execution.
EN 1991-1-6: 2005. European Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2006. Eurocode 1 - Actions on structures. Part 1-7: General actions. Accidental actions. EN
1991-1-7: 2006. European Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2003. Eurocode 1 - Actions on structures. Part 2: Traffic loads on bridges. EN 1991-2: 2003.
European Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2006. Eurocode 1 - Actions on structures. Part 3: Actions induced by cranes and machinery. EN
1991-3: 2006. European Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2004. Eurocode 2 Design of concrete structures. Part 1-1: General rules and rules for
buildings. EN 1992-1-1: 2004. European Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2005. Eurocode 2 Design of concrete structures. Part 2: Concrete bridges. Design and
detailing rules. EN 1992-2: 2005. European Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2005. Eurocode 3 Design of steel structures. Part 1-1: General rules and rules for buildings.
EN 1993-1-1: 2005. European Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2005. Eurocode 3 Design of steel structures. Part 1-9: Fatigue. EN 1993-1-9: 2005. European
Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2006. Eurocode 3 Design of steel structures. Part 2: Steel bridges. EN 1993-2: 2006.
European Committee for Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2004. Eurocode 4 Design of composite steel and concrete structures. Part 1-1: General rules
and rules for buildings. EN 1994-1-1: 2004. European Committee for Standardization (CEN):
Brussels.
CEN 2005. Eurocode 4 Design of composite steel and concrete structures. Part 2: General rules
and rules for bridges. EN 1994-2: 2005. European Committee for Standardization (CEN):
Brussels.
Davaine L. 2010. Global analysis of a steel-concrete composite two-girder bridge according to
Eurocode 4, Note for Workshop Bridge design to Eurocodes to be held in Vienna, 4-6 October
2010.
Malakatas N. 2010. Example of application for wind actions on bridge deck and piers, Note for
Workshop Bridge design to Eurocodes to be held in Vienna, 4-6 October 2010.
Ortega Cornejo, M., Raoul, J. 2010. Composite bridge design (EN1994-2). Illustration of basic
element design, Note for Workshop Bridge design to Eurocodes to be held in Vienna, 4-6
October 2010.
76
CHAPTER 4
78
4.1 Introduction
The global structural analysis of the composite twin girder bridge given in introduction is presented
here. The first step of this analysis is the bridge modelling. For the longitudinal global bending
behaviour only one structural steel girder with half of the reinforced concrete slab is modelled. The
structural analysis is a first order elastic linear one. The calculation of the elastic mechanical
properties for each cross section requires:
o
the different modular ratios between concrete and steel (creep effect)
The second step of the global analysis is the calculation of the internal forces and moments
distribution along the whole girder. The analysis should respect the construction phases and takes
into account the concrete cracking on internal supports by a simplified method. The cracked global
analysis is performed according to EN 1994-2 rules.
The results of this global analysis in terms of internal forces and moments, stresses and deformations,
will be linearly combined following the combinations of actions defined in EN 1990 for the
Serviceability Limit State (SLS) and the Ultimate Limit State (ULS). More detailed information about
the load cases definition and the combination rules are also given in another chapter of this Report.
The further chapters are devoted to the section analysis and other design verifications based on the
outcome of this global analysis.
bf
bf
tw
2
1200 18
2
notations.
As b0
(80 m long) of the bridge, the bottom flange width is not reduced to an effective width for the global
analysis (see EN 1993-1-5, 2.2).
79
0.7L2
b0
Le
56 m for the inner span, and for the support regions around the piers P1 and
0.85L1
0.25 60 80
35 m .
b0
750 mm for the centre-to-centre distance between the outside stud rows
bei
min
Le
; bi
8
and bi is the actual geometric width of the slab associated to the main girder
o
b1
7.0 m b0
2
2
b2
2.5 m b0
2
2
2.125 m for the cantilever slab outside the main steel girder
As
0.55 0.025
Le
bei
Le
is always greater than bi for the example it is deduced that the effective width is equal to the
8
actual width except for the cross-sections at end supports C0 and C3 where the factor
o
0.55 0.025
Le1
be1
0.55 0.025
0.55 0.025
Le1
be 2
0.55 0.025
51
3.125
0.958 1.0
51
1.15 but should be
2.125
80
1.0 so
influences:
b eff
b 0 = 750 mm 2b e2
1b e1
b 1 = 3.125 mm
b 2 = 2.125 mm
Fig. 4.1 Effective width in the concrete slab for the section analysis
Finally the slab width will linearly vary from 0.750 m+0.958*3.125 m+1.0*2.125 m = 5.869 m at end
support C0 to 6.0 m for the abscissa 0.25 L1 = 15 m in the span C0-P1. Afterwards it will be constant
and equal to 6.0 m up to the abscissa 2L1 + L2 0.25L1 = 185 m and then it will vary linearly from 6.0 m
to 5.869 m at end support C3.
This variable effective width is always taken into account to calculate the longitudinal stress
distribution.
n0 =
Ea
=
Ecm
210000
f
22000 cm
10
0,3
210000
35 + 8
22000
10
0,3
= 6.16
where Ea and Ecm are respectively the modulus of elasticity for the structural steel and the concrete.
L ) and on the creep level at the time considered (through the creep coefficient ( t , t 0 ) ):
nL = n0 . 1 + L . ( t , t0 )
81
conveys the dependence of the modular ratio on the type of applied loading :
o
= 1.1
o
concrete shrinkage:
settlement :
t , t0
0.
t , t0
0.
RH
fcm .
t0
= 0.55
= 1.5
t0
t t0
RH
100 .
0.10. 3 h0
0.3
. 2.
16.8
and
(otherwise
35
1
h0
fcm
0.7
0.87 and
1
0.1 t 0
0.2
The coefficients
fcm
35
2
fcm
35 MPa
0.2
0.96
2 Ac
is the notional size of the slab, with Ac
u
perimeter exposed to drying. The asphalt layer width (11 m) and the upper steel flange widths (2 x 1.0
m) should be extracted from the actual perimeter is p = 24.6 m to get u p 11 2 * 1.0 11.6 m .
Finally h0
672 mm .
As a simplification EN1994-2 allows to use only one mean value for t 0 when applying the load cases
corresponding to all the slab concreting phases. Regarding the very low influence of the choice of t 0
on the final distribution of internal forces and moments, and the difficulties to get the final concreting
sequence during the project design, a reasonable approach consists in taking t 0 equal to half the
concreting time of the entire slab, t 0 = 66/2 = 33 days for the example.
o
Concrete shrinkage:
Shrinkage is assumed to begin as soon as the concrete is poured and extends through its lifetime.
EN1994-2 imposes a value of t 0 = 1 day for evaluating the corresponding modular ratio.
o
Settlement:
The 3 cm settlement is assumed to occur at t 0 = 50 days when the self-weight of the bridge deck is
entirely applied to the structure. This hypothesis can be discussed for an actual bridge design.
82
Load case
Concreting
Shrinkage
Bridge equipments
Settlement
1.10
0.55
1.10
1.50
t0 (days)
33
1
88
50
, t0
1.4
2.7
1.2
1.3
nL
n0 . 1
, t0
15.6
15.2
14.1
18.1
Aa
As
area of the reinforcing steel of the composite cross-section (within the effective width for
shear lag)
Ab
area of the concrete part of the composite cross-section (within the effective width for shear
lag)
modular ratio
Ia
second moment of area of the structural steel part of the composite cross-section
Ib
Ed
Aa
Ab
n
Ab
y Gb
n
Ay G
Aa y Ga
Aa y G y Ga
Ia
1
Ib
n
Ab y G y Gb
83
beff
Gc
y Gc
elastic
neutral axis
yG
Ga
y Ga
beff
Gs
y Gs
G
yG
Ga
elastic
neutral axis
y Ga
A
Ay G
Aa
As
Aa y Ga
As y Gs
I Ia Aa yG yGa
As y G y Gs
84
0)
For the longitudinal bending global analysis, the self-weight of the in-span located transverse crossgirders is modelled by a vertical uniformly distributed load of 1500 N/m applied to each main girder
(about 10% of the weight of this main girder).
Density of the reinforced concrete: 25 kN/m
The self-weight of the structural steel is resisted by the steel structure alone whereas the self-weight
of the poured concrete (segment by segment) is resisted by a main girder which is partially concreted
according to the construction sequence.
Characteristics
Maximum multiplier
Minimum multiplier
1.0
1.0
Safety barrier
65 kg/ml
1.0
1.0
Cornice
25 kg/ml
1.0
1.0
Waterproofing layer
3 cm thick
1.2
0.8
Asphalt layer
8 cm thick
1.4
0.8
Concrete support
the safety barrier
of
The multiplier coefficients are defined in EN 1991-1-1. For the waterproofing and asphalt layers, they
take into account the uncertainty on the thickness and a further retrofitting of the asphalt layer during
the bridge lifetime.
Density of the waterproofing material and of the asphalt: 25 kN/m
The table below gives the uniformly distributed loads to apply to one of the bridge composite girder to
get the envelope of the internal forces and moments distribution for the non-structural bridge
equipments.
qnom (kN/ml)
qmin (kN/ml)
qmax (kN/ml)
2.5
2.5
2.5
Safety barrier
0.638
0.638
0.638
Cornice
0.245
0.245
0.245
Waterproofing layer
4.2
5.04
3.36
Asphalt layer
11
15.4
8.8
Total
18.6 kN/ml
23.8 kN/ml
15.5 kN/ml
Item
Concrete support
the safety barrier
of
85
corresponding to the first opening to traffic loads (persistent design situation for tini = 110 days) and at
infinite time (persistent design situation for tfin = 100 years). Thermal shrinkage is dealt with in
EN1994-2 as it is a peculiarity of a composite structure.
4.5.3.1 Shrinkage deformation at traffic opening
The calculation of cs requires the age t of the concrete at the considered date tini. At this date each
slab segment has a different age. To simplify, the mean value of the ages of all slab segments is
considered taking account of the construction phases: t = 66/2 + 44 = 77 days. The formulae from
Annex B and 3.1.4 in EN1992-1-1 are used.
ca ( t ) = as ( t ) ca ( ) with ca ( ) = 2.5 ( fck - 10 )10-6 = 6.25 10-5 and as ( t ) = 1- exp -0.2 t = 0.83 for
t = 77 days. Finally ca ( t ) = 5.2 10
fcm
fcm0
cd ( t ) = ds ( t , t s ) .kh cd,0 with cd,0 = 0.85. ( 220 + 110. ds1 ) .exp ds2
6
.10 .RH
RH
= 0.76 with RH = 80%
100
3
RH = 1.55. 1
fcm 0 = 10 MPa
ds1 = 4 and ds 2 = 0.12 for the hardening speed of a normal type of cement (class N)
Finally cd ,0 = 2.53 104
ds ( t,t s ) =
t ts
t t s + 0.04. h0
86
ds ( ,t s ) =
1.
Subsequently
cs ( ) = cd ( ) + ca ( )
with
ca ( ) = 6.25 10 5
and
cd ( ) = kh cd,0 = 1.77 10 .
4
Finally cs ( ) = 2.4 10 4 is applied to the complete concrete slab (in a single phase). This action is
incorporated for the bridge verifications in the load combinations for the persistent design situation at
infinite time.
4.5.3 3 Thermal shrinkage
EN1994-2 7.4.1(6) takes account of the thermal shrinkage produced by the difference in temperature
T between structural steel and concrete when concreting. The recommended value is T = 20C
thus giving a strain th = th T = 105 20K = 2 104 which is relatively high.
In fact, on-site measurements show that this temperature difference seems correct but a part of the
corresponding thermal shrinkage applies to a structure which has not yet a composite behaviour. For
this reason a half value ( th = 1 104 ) has been used in this bridge design example.
The thermal shrinkage applies to the composite structure with the early age shrinkage cs = 7 105 . It
should normally be used only to determine the cracked zones of the global analysis and to control the
crack width in the concrete slab.
87
0.50
1.00
3.00
3.00
Traffic lane no 2
Girder no 1
2.00
Traffic lane no 3
Traffic lane no 1
3.00
Remaining area
Girder no 2
3.50
3.50
TS 1 per axle :
1.0 x 300 = 300 kN
TS 2 per axle :
1.0 x 200 = 200 kN
TS 3 per axle :
1.0 x 100 = 100 kN
R1 (Reaction
force in the
0.50 girder no 1)
1.00
R2
2.00
(Reaction
force in the
girder no 2)
Transverse
influence line
88
300 kN 7m 0.5m
7m
1m
2
200 kN
7m
2m
2
100 kN
R1 7m
Load on lane no 1:
1.0 x 9 x 3 = 27 kN m
Load on lane no 2:
1.0 x 2.5 x 3 = 7.5 kN m
Load on lane no 3:
1.0 x 2.5 x 3 = 7.5 kN m
LANE 1
R1
(Reaction
force in the
0.50 girder no 1)
LANE 3
Axis of the bridge
LANE 2
1.00
R2 (Reaction
0
2.00
force in the
girder no 2)
Transverse
influence line
Qlk
180
0.6
Q1
Q1
Qlk
2Q1k
0.1
q 1 1k
900 kN
89
calculated by loading systematically all the longitudinal influence lines and two envelopes are finally
obtained for the two traffic load types.
20
UDL
TS
15
10
0
0
20
40
60
80
100
120
140
160
180
200
-5
-10
-15
-20
Figure 4.7 Bending moments due to UDL and TS in the bridge deck
90
example) then the concrete in this cross-section should be considered as cracked for the second step
of the cracked global analysis. This criterion thus defines cracked zones on both sides of the
intermediate supports on shown in Fig. 4.8.
For the second step of the global analysis, the concrete slab stiffness in the cracked zones is reduced
to the stiffness of its reinforcing steel in tension. The calculations from the first step are then
reproduced with this new longitudinal stiffness distribution. The concrete shrinkage should not be
applied to the cross sections located in the cracked zones. Finally the internal forces and moments as well as the corresponding stress distributions at the end of this second step of analysis are used
in the following chapters of this Report to justify all the transverse cross-sections of the bridge deck.
It should be noticed that the symmetry and the length of the cracked zones are very much influenced
by the concreting sequence of the slab.
91
Designation
C0 (MN)
P1 (MN)
Gk1
1.1683
5.2867
Gk2
0.39769
1.4665
3 cm settlement on support P1
Sk
0.060
-0.137
Traffic UDL
UDL
0.97612
2.693
Traffic TS
TS
0.92718
0.94458
To get the maximum (resp. minimum) value of the vertical support reaction for the non structural
equipments, the nominal value should be multiplied by the coefficient 1.28 (resp. 0.83). Moreover
these values should be combined according to the SLS and ULS combinations of actions from EN
1990.
92
93
References
[1]
Eurocode 3 and 4, Application to steel-concrete composite road bridges, Setras guidance
book published in July 2007. This book can be downloaded at the following web address:
http://www.setra.equipement.gouv.fr/Technical-guides.html
[2]
Eurocode 4 : Design of composite steel and concrete structures, Part 2 : General rules and
rules for bridges, February 2006
[3]
Eurocode 3 : Design of steel structures, Part 1-5 : Plated structural elements, March 2007
[4]
94
CHAPTER 5
Giuseppe Mancini
Politecnico di Torino
96
5.1 Introduction
This chapter presents the practical application of some main issues of Eurocode 2. It does not deal
with advanced methods of analysis and design. It mainly focuses on standard or simplified methods.
On the example of the concrete slab of the composite deck, will be illustrated the application of
section 4 (durability), section 6 (ultimate limit states) and section 7 (serviceability limit states) of
EN1992-1-1 and EN1992-2. Then, the analysis of second order effects by a simplified method is
presented on the high pier case. This is an issue of section 5 of EN1992-1-1.
fatigue,
punching shear.
The verifications in this chapter are presented for two specific longitudinal sections of the concrete
slab above the main steel girder and at mid-span between the main steel girders under transverse
bending moment. The emphasis is on the peculiar topics for a composite bridge concrete slab,
particularly the fact that it is in tension longitudinally around the internal supports.
97
cmin,dur
(durability)
is
given
in
table
the exposure class (table 4.1)
the structural class (table 4.3N)
4.4N,
it
depends
on
The basic structural class is 4. Table 4.3 gives the correction to apply following different criteria. For
instance, for the top face of the slab, which exposure class is XC3, the structural class is increased by
2 because the design working life is 100 years,
years, then reduced by 1 because of the strength class of
compaction), and by 1 because of slab geometry, and again by 1 for
concrete (closely related to its compaction),
special control of concrete production, which is normally the case for bridges.
98
4.4.1.3 (1)P)
cmin,b
cmin,dur
cdev
cnom
20
20
10
30
25
30
10
40
Of course, durability is not only a matter of concrete compaction and minimum cover. It must be one
of the main concerns at all the stages of conceptual design.
For the verification, we use an equivalent beam model. But for the analysis, it is necessary to take into
traffic loads, which are not uniformly
account the 2-dimensional behaviour of the slab, at least for traffic
distributed.
99
a) Permanent loads
The internal forces and moments under permanent loads are pure bending and may be calculated
from a truss element model. A transverse slab strip which is 1-m-wide in the bridge longitudinal
direction is modelled as an isostatic girder lying on two vertical point supports representing the
boundaries with the main steel girders. This hypothesis is unfavourable regarding the partially blocked
boundary conditions that are applied to the concrete slab in relation with the width bf of the upper steel
flange. This isostatic model is subjected to the variable distributed loads concrete self-weight and
non-structural bridge equipments according to Fig. 5.3.
After performing all calculations, the transverse bending moments in Fig. 5.4 are obtained.
100
b) Traffic loads
The internal forces and moments are obtained reading charts which have been established by
SETRA for the local bending of the slab in two-girder bridge with transverse girders. These charts are
derived from the calculation of influence surfaces on a finite element model of a typical composite
deck slab. The traffic load model LM1 is always governing the design.
For the studied slab section located above the steel main girder, the characteristic value of the
transverse bending moment is equal to MLM1 = -158 kN.m and the frequent value is equal to MLM1 = 110 kN.m.
For the studied slab section at mid-span between the steel main girders, the characteristic value of
the transverse bending moment is equal to MLM1 = 160 kN.m and the frequent value is equal to MLM1 =
108 kN.m.
c) Combinations of actions
Using the combinations of actions defined in this chapter finally gives the bending moment values in
Table 5.2 below (for a 1-m-wide slab strip):
101
Quasi permanent
SLS
Frequent SLS
Characteristic
SLS
ULS
-46
-156
-204
-275
Section at midspan
24
132
184
248
f
As,min = 026 ctm bt d 00013bt d
fyk
where bt is the slab width (reasoning here is based on a 1-m-wide slab strip therefore bt = 1 m) and d
is the effective depth of the cross-section (i.e. the distance between the centre of gravity of the
considered reinforcement layer and the extreme compressed fibre of the concrete).
For the design example, the reinforcement area which has been used in the design is clearly greater
2
2
than the minimum reinforcement area: As,min = 6.0 cm /m above the main girder and 4.3 cm /m at midspan.
5.2.2.3 ULS bending resistance
The design value of the bending moment MEd at ULS should be less than the design value of the
resistance bending moment MRd which is calculated according to the following stress-strain
relationships:
o
for the reinforcement, a bi-linear stress-strain relationship with strain hardening (Class B
steel bars according to Annex C to EN1992-1-1):
102
s = Ess
for s fyd / Es
s =
cu3 (d x)/x
103
That means that, if the tensile stresses, calculated in the uncracked cross-section, are not greater
than fctm, then there is no need to perform a calculation of normal stresses under the assumption of
cracked cross-section.
5.2.2.5 Stress limitation for characteristic SLS combination of actions
Stress limitations under characteristic combination are checked to avoid inelastic deformation of the
reinforcement and longitudinal cracks in concrete. It is an irreversible limit state. The following
limitations should be checked (EN1992-1-1, 7.2(5) and 7.2(2)):
s k3fyk = 0.8x500 = 400 MPa
c k1fck = 0.6x35 = 21 MPa
where k1 and k3 are defined by the National Annex to EN1992-1-1. The recommended values are
k1 = 0.6 and k3 = 0.8.
Stresses are calculated in the cracked section, assuming linear elastic behaviour of the materials and
neglecting the contribution of concrete in tension. The results depend on the modular ratio n
(reinforcement/concrete), which lies between the short term value (Es/Ecm) and the long term value,
approximately equal to 15. The value to take into account depends on the ratio between the moments
under characteristic combination and quasi-permanent combination. To be rigorous, two calculations
should be performed: a short-term calculation with the short term value of n and a long term
calculation taking into account the long-term effects of permanent loads and the short-term effects of
traffic loads.
The most unfavourable compressive stresses c in the concrete are generally provided by the shortterm calculations, performed with a modular ratio n = Es/Ecm = 5.9 (Es = 200 GPa for reinforcing steel
and Ecm = 34 GPa for concrete C35/45). The most unfavourable tensile stresses s in the
reinforcement are generally provided by the long-term calculations, performed with n = 15.
2
The design example in the section above the steel main girder gives d = 0.36 m, As = 18.48 cm and
M = 0.204 MN.m.
Using n = 15, s = 344 MPa < 400 MPa is obtained.
Using n = 5.9, c = 15,6 MPa < 21 MPa is obtained.
The design example in the section at mid-span between the steel main girders gives d = 0.26 m,
2
As = 28.87 cm and M = 0.184 MN.m.
Using n = 15, s = 287 MPa < 400 MPa is obtained.
104
M = 24 kNm/m
c = 1.5 MPa
Since c > - fctm , the sections are assumed to be uncracked (EN1992-1-1, 7.1(2)) and there is no
need to check the crack openings. A minimum amount of bonded reinforcement is required in areas
where tension is expected (EN1992-1-1 and EN1992-2, 7.3.2). The minimum area of tensile
reinforcement is given by expression (7.1), which is obtained from equilibrium between the tensile
force in concrete just before cracking and tensile force in reinforcement just after cracking:
As,mins = kckfct,effAct
where
o
Act is the area of concrete within the tensile zone just before the formation of the first
crack
kc takes account of the stress distribution and of the change of lever arm when cracking
occurs.
s = fyk (a lower value needs be taken only when control of cracking is ensured limiting bar
size or spacing according to 7.3.3).
105
As,min = 3.33 cm /m on top face of the slab above the main girders
at mid-span
c = 5.9 MPa
M = 156 kN.m/m
c = 8.2 MPa
M = 132 kN.m/m
Both sections are cracked under frequent combination. Normal stresses in concrete and steel must be
calculated in the cracked cross-section. Control of crack width can then be done by the direct method
(EN1992-1-1, 7.3.4). The crack width is given by:
wk = sr,max (sm - cm)
where
o
fct,eff
1+e p,eff
p,eff
Es
where
o
e = Es/Ecm
= As/Ac,eff
kt = 0.6 for short term loading and 0.4 for long term loading.
If the spacing of reinforcement is less than 5(c + /2), sr,max may be given by:
sr,max = k3c + k1k2k4/p,eff
where k1 = 0.8 (high bond bars), k2 = 0.5 (bending), k3 = 3.4 and k4 = 0.425.
Design example
For a rectangular section without axial force, the depth of the neutral axis x is equal to:
wk = 0.20 mm
106
at mid-span
n = 7.6
M = 132 kNm
h = 0.318 m
d = 0.26 m
2
= 0.025 m
As = 28.87 cm c = 0.04 m
Then
x = 0.077 m
hc,ef = 0.077 m
s = 198 MPa
2
Ac,eff = 0.077 m p,eff = 0.0375
kt = 0.6
sm - cm = 0.68.10-3
sr,,max = 0.25 m
Finally
wk = 0.17 mm
VRd,c = bwd k1
cp maxCRd,c k
100l fck 1/3 vmin
where:
o
k = 1+
200
d
2.0
with d in mm
o l = Asl 0.02
bw d
Asl is the area of reinforcement in tension (see Figure 6.3 in EN1992-2 for the provisions that have to
be fulfilled by this reinforcement). For the design example, Asl represents the transverse reinforcing
steel bars of the upper layer in the studied section above the steel main girder. bw is the smallest
width of the studied section in the tensile area. In the studied slab bw = 1000 mm in order to obtain a
resistance VRd,c to vertical shear for a 1-m-wide slab strip (rectangular section).
o
cp
NEd
0,2fcd in MPa. This stress is equal to zero where there is no normal force
Ac
The values of CRd,c and k1 can be given by the National Annex to EN1992-2. The
recommended ones are used:
CRd,c =
c =012
018
k1 = 0.15
o
3/2
1/2
Design example
The design example in the studied slab section above the steel main girder gives successively:
fck = 35 MPa
CRd,c = 0.12
d = 360 mm
107
k=1+
200
360
= 1.75
2
Asl = 1848 mm (high bond bars with diameter of 20 mm and spacing of 170 mm).
bw = 1000 mm
l =
1848
= 0.51%
1000x360
CRd,ck(100lfck)
1/3
= 0.55 MPa
cp = 0
3/2
1/2
z is the inner lever arm (z = 0.9d may normally be used for members without axial force)
is the angle of the compression strut with the horizontal, must be chosen such as
1 cot 2.5
1 is a strength reduction factor for concrete cracked in shear, the recommended value
of 1 is = 0.6(1-fck/250)
108
cw is a coefficient taking account of the interaction of the stress in the compression chord
and any applied axial compressive stress;
stress; the recommended value of cw is 1 for non
prestressed members.
2
In the design example, choosing cot = 2.5, with a shear reinforcement area Asw/s = 6.8 cm /m for a
1-m-wide slab strip:
VRd,s = 0.00068x(0.9x0.36)x435x2.5 = 240 kN/m > VEd
VRd,max = 1.0x1.0x(0.9x0.36)x0.6x(1 35/250)x35/(2.5+0.4) = 2.02 MN/m > VEd
Note
In EN1992-1-1, the shear resistance without shear reinforcement is the same for beams and for slabs.
This does not take account of the 2-dimensional behaviour of slabs and of the possibility of transverse
redistribution. The calibration of the expression of vmin is based on tests made on beam elements only.
For these reasons,vmin has been modified by the French National Annex to EN1992-1-1 :
3/2 1/2
vmin = 0.035 k fck for beam elements (it is the recommended value)
1/2
vmin = (0.34/c) fck for slab elements where transverse redistribution of loads is possible. This
is based on French experience. Such a difference already existed in former French code. With this
expression: vmin = (0.34/1.5).351/2 = 1.34 MPa > 0.55 MPa and there is no need to add shear
reinforcement in the slab.
5.2.2.8 Resistance to longitudinal shear stress
The longitudinal shear force per unit length at the steel/concrete interface is determined by an elastic
analysis at characteristic SLS and at ULS. The number of shear connectors is designed thereof, to
resist to this shear force per unit length and thus to ensure the longitudinal composite behaviour of the
deck.
Fig. 5.9 Shear force per unit length resisted by the studs (MN/m)
At ULS this longitudinal shear stress should also be resisted to for any potential surface of longitudinal
shear failure within the slab. This means that the reinforcing steel bars holing such kind of surface
109
should be designed to prevent any shear failure of the concrete or any longitudinal splitting within the
slab.
Two potential surfaces of shear failure are defined in EN1994-2, 6.6.6.1 (see Fig. 5.10(a)):
o
surface a-a holing only once by the two transverse reinforcement layers, As = Asup + Ainf
surface b-b holing twice by the lower transverse reinforcement layer, As = 2.Ainf
where:
o
Fd is the change of the normal force in the flange over the length x.
110
Fig. 5.11 Shear between web and flanges (fig. 6.7 of EN1992-1-1)
The longitudinal shear stress causes horizontal compressive struts in the concrete slab. They are
inclined with an angle f with regards to the longitudinal axis of the deck (see Fig. 5.10(b) and Fig.
5.11).
The calculation is made only for the surface a-a on the central slab side, where the longitudinal shear
is higher than on cantilever side.
Shear stress: vEd = Fd/(hf x) = 0.81/0.40 = 2.03 MPa (hf = 0.40 m)
Two different verifications should be carried out:
o
A
vEd hf tanf ss fyd
where s is the spacing between the transverse reinforcing steel bars and As is the
corresponding area within the 1-m-wide slab strip.
o
with
shear).
f
= 0.61- ck and fck in MPa (strength reduction factor for the concrete cracked in
250
As the concrete slab is in tension in the longitudinal direction of the deck, the angle f for the concrete
compressive strut should be limited to cotan f = 1.25 i.e. f = 38.65.
For the design example, above the steel main girder, the transverse reinforcement is made of high
bond bars with a 20 mm diameter for the upper layer, and of high bond bars with a 16 mm diameter
2
for the lower layer with a spacing s = 170 mm, i.e. As/s = 30.3 cm /m. The previous criterion is thus
verified:
As s
vEd hf
fyd cotan f
= 0.81/(435x1.25) = 14.9 cm /m
111
The second criterion is also verified for the shear plane a-a:
vEd = 2.03 MPa .fcd.sinf.cosf = 6.02 MPa.
A minimum reinforcement area of 14.9 cm/m should be put in the concrete slab in order to prevent
the longitudinal shear failure for the surface a-a.
vEd hf
fyd cotan f
the criterion for preventing the crushing in the compressive struts (see paragraph 5.2.2.8)
is verified with a height hf reduced by the depth of the compressive zone considered in the
transverse bending assessment (as this concrete is worn out under compression, it
cannot simultaneously take up the shear stress);
the total reinforcement area should be not less than Aflex + Ashear/2 where Aflex is the
reinforcement area needed for the pure bending assessment and Ashear is the
reinforcement area needed for the pure longitudinal shear flow. Eurocode 2 does not
specify how to distribute the final total reinforcement area between the two layers.
112
If these conditions are not satisfied, a more refined method given in annex MM may be used.
5.2.2.10 ULS of fatigue under transverse bending
For this verification, the slow lane is assumed to be close to the parapet and the fatigue load is
centred on this lane.
113
Fig. 5.13 Load model FLM3 (axle loads 120 kN) Variation of bending moment.
The variation of the transverse bending moment in the section above the main steel girder during the
passage of FLM3 is calculated using a finite element model of the slab. The moment variation is equal
to 39 kNm/m. The corresponding stress range in the reinforcement is calculated assuming a cracked
cross section (even if under permanent loads, the section may be considered as uncracked):
s(FLM3) = 63 MPa
The damage equivalent stress range method is defined in EN1992-1-1, 6.8.5 and the procedure for
road traffic load on bridges is detailed in EN1992-2, Annex NN.
Adequate fatigue resistance of the reinforcing (or prestressing) steel should be assumed if the
following expression is satisfied:
F ,fat = S ,eq ( N )
Rsk ( N )
F ,fat
where:
Rsk(N*)
is the stress range at N* cycles from the appropriate S-N curve in Figure
6.30. For reinforcement made of straight or bent bars, Rsk(N*) = 162.5 MPa
(EN1992-1-1, table 6.3N)
S,eq(N*)
is the damage equivalent stress range for the reinforcement and considering
the number of loading cycles N*.
F,fat
is the partial factor for fatigue load (EN1992-1-1, 2.4.2.3). The recommended
value is 1.0
s,fat
The equivalent damage stress range is calculated according to EN1992, Annex NN, NN.2.1:
s,equ = s,Ec.s
where
o
fat
114
s,1
takes account of the type of member and the length of the influence line or
surface
o
s,2
s,3
s,4
Fig. 5.14 s,1 value for fatigue verification (EN1992-2, Figure NN.2)
s,1 is given by figure NN.2, curve 3c). In the design example, the length of the influence line is 2,5 m.
Therefore, s,1 1.1
k2
N
obs (expression NN.103)
s,2 =
2.0
where
o
Nobs is the number of lories per year according to EN1991-2, Table 4.5
k2
is the slope of the appropriate S-N line to be taken from Tables 6.3N and
6.4N of EN1992-1-1
115
Finally:
s,2 = 0.81
s,3 = 1
s,4 = 1
fat = 1.0
except for the areas close to the expansion joints where fat = 1.3
It comes:
s = 0.89
For the design example, depending on t0, cc(t0) is lying between 1,1 and 1,2 and fcd,fat is between 16
and 17.5 MPa. The maximum and minimum compressive stresses on the lower fibre calculated in
the cracked section with a modular ratio equal to 5.9 are 11.9 MPa and 3.5 MPa. The condition is
not satisfied. However, this condition is very conservative and does not represent the effects of cyclic
traffic load: the effects of the frequent traffic loads are much more aggressive than those of fatigue
traffic loads. Moreover, the design fatigue strength is based on fcd, calculated with the recommended
value of cc, equal to 0.85 in EN1992-2. It seems to be no reason to take this value relevant for long
term loading for fatigue verifications (with cc = 1 and cc(t0) = 1,2 the condition given by Expr.6.77 is
satisfied).
For concrete fatigue verification, there is no method of damage equivalent stress range as for
reinforcement. Such a method, intermediate between the rough and conservative condition of
Expr.6.77 and a more sophisticated method using traffic data, would be useful.
116
MPa in the upper layer and to s,inf = 166 MPa in the lower layer (see Figure 6.6 in the chapter
Composite bridge design). The corresponding values for the internal forces and moments in the
concrete slab are:
Nglob = As,sups,sup + As,infs,inf
2
117
vEd,i is the design value of the shear stress at the joint interface,
is the reinforcement ratio of longitudinal high bond bars holing the interface (assumed to
be perpendicular to the interface plane),
, c are parameters depending on the roughness quality for the interface. In case of
interface in tension c = 0.
= 0.6(1 fck/250) with fck in MPa (strength reduction factor for the concrete cracked in
shear).
The shear stresses at the interface are small (in the order of 0.2 MPa). But applying the formula
directly can cause problems as it gives vRdi < 0 as soon as n + fyd < 0
i.e n < 1.19% x 435 MPa = -5.18 MPa in the design example. The ULS stress calculation assuming
an uncracked behaviour of the composite cross-sections shows that this tensile stress is exceeded on
piers.
In fact, as the slab is cracked at ULS, Acn should be taken as equal to the tensile force in the
longitudinal reinforcement of the cracked cross-section, i.e.:
n = - (As,sups,sup + As,infs,inf)/Ac
(as this involves ULS calculations, the tension stiffening effects are not taken into account)
In the design example, the following is obtained for the joint interface closest to the cross-section at
support P1:
n = - 0.73% x 190 MPa 0.46% x 166 MPa = - 2.15 MPa
The shear resistance vRd,i is deduced:
vRdi = (n + fyd) = (2.15 + 5.18) = .3.24 MPa
= 0.7 if a good roughness quality is assumed at the interface. Hence vRd,i = 2.27 MPa. The
resistance to shear at the joint interface is thus verified.
118
Design value of the shear stress vEd around the control perimeter
The vertical load is applied on a shear surface u1d in the concrete slab. The shear stress is then given
by:
vEd =
VEd
u1d
where:
o
1/3
where:
o
fck is in MPa
k = 1
200
2.0 with d in mm
d
l = ly lz 0.02 is the ratio of reinforcement in tension (lower layer) in the two
119
cy +cz
cp =
In the concrete slab of a composite bridge, around an internal support, there is no tension in the
transverse direction but the tensile stress is very high in the longitudinal direction (about -9 MPa for
the design example). This gives thus:
k1 = 0.12
These values are different from those recommended by EN1992-1-1 (0.18/c and 0.1).It will be seen
that the note in EN1994-2, 6.2.2.5(3), only relates to concrete flanges in tension (cp < 0) as part of a
steel/concrete composite structural beam, which is the case here in the longitudinal direction. In case
of a concrete slab under bending moment or compression, the values for CRd,c and k1 would have
been provided by the National Annex to EN1992-1-1. See also paragraph 5.2.2.7.
o
vmin = 0.035 k
3/2
1/2
fck
VEd
= 0.18 MPa (with = 1)
u1d
200
= 1.90 2.0
249
cp = - 1.85 MPa
CRd,c = 0.10
k1 = 0.12
CRd,ck(100lfck)
1/3
= 0.48 MPa
3/2
1/2
x 35
120
Pier height : 40 m
Pier shaft
o
external diameter : 4 m
Ac = 4.52 m
Ic = 7.42 m
As = 678 cm
Is = 0.110 m
4
2
Pier head:
volume : 54 m
Weight : 1.35 MN
Concrete
o
C35/45
fck = 35 MPa
121
Ic is the uncracked inertia of the pier shaft, Is is the second moment of area of the reinforcement about
the centre of area of the concrete cross-section.
Fy (trans.)
Fx (long.)
Mx (trans.)
14.12 MN
UDL
3.51 MN
8.44 MN.m
TS
1.21 MN
2.42 MN.m
Braking
0.45 MN
0.036 MN
0.11 MN.m
Tk
0.06 MN
Comb 1
25.43 MN
0.032 MN
14.76 MN.m
Comb 2
22.18 MN
0.66 MN
7.01 MN.m
l = 0h
where
under
permanent
combination
122
ef = (,t0).M0Eqp / M0Ed
where:
(,t0)
M0Eqp
M0Ed
ef = 2 (1.12/28.2) = 0.08
Nominal stiffness (EN1992-1-1, 5.8.7.2 (1)
EI = KcEcdIc + KsEsIs
(Expression 5.21)
where:
Ecd
Ic
Es
Is
Kc
Ks
is the design value of the modulus of elasticity of concrete, see 5.8.6 (3)
is
the
moment
of
inertia
of
concrete
cross
section
is the design value of the modulus of elasticity of reinforcement, 5.8.6 (3)
is the second moment of area of reinforcement, about the centre of area of
the concrete
is a factor for effects of cracking, creep etc, see 5.8.7.2 (2) or (3)
is a factor for contribution of reinforcement, see 5.8.7.2 (2) or (3)
The expression (5.21) is the sum of the full stiffness of the reinforcement (Ks = 1) and of the reduced
stiffness of the concrete, function of the axial force and of the slenderness of the pier.
In the design example:
Ecd= Ecm/cE = 34000/1.2 = 28300 MPa
Ic = 7.42 m
Es = 200000 MPa
Is = 0.110 m
Ks = 1
Kc is given by the following expression
Kc = k1k2 / (1 + ef)
where:
k1 = fck /20(MPa)
k2 = n
170
0.20
where:
n
= 0.015
k1 = 1.32
123
NEd = 22.18 MN
n = 22.18/(4.52.19.8) = 0.25
= l0/i ; l0 = 1.43.l = 57.20 m (taking into account the rigidity of the second pier) ; i = (Ic/Ac)0,5
= 1.28 m
l0 is the effective length of the elastic buckling mode. It is calculated taking into account the restraints
at the end of the column. Here, the pier is assumed to have a full restraint at the bottom. Due to the
presence of the other pier, there is an elastic restraint for the horizontal displacement at the top. This
can be modeled by a spring which stiffness is equal to 3EI/l3 (taking the same EI for both piers). In the
longitudinal direction, the rotation is free at the top of the pier.
= 45
k2 = 0.25.(45/170) = 0.066
M0Ed
NEd
NB
NB NEd -1
"
(5.28)
(2)
For isolated members with constant cross section and axial load, the second order moment
may normally be assumed having a sine-shaped distribution. Then
= 2 / c0
(5.29)
In the design example, c0 = 12, assuming a triangular distribution of the first order moment. Then:
M0Ed = 28.2 MN.m
NB = EI/l0 = 118 MN
NEd = 26 MN (mean value on the height of the pier)
Finally, the moment magnification factor is equal to 1.23, and:
MEd = 1.23 M0Ed = 33.3 MN.m
This method gives a safe design of the piers, but it is possible that the longitudinal displacements are
overestimated. For a better assessment of the displacements, a general method, based on momentcurvature relationship is necessary.
124
CHAPTER 6
Jol RAOUL
Assistant to the Director of Large Bridge Division. Stra/CTOA
Prof. at Ecole Nationale de Ponts et Chausss. Paris. France.
Convenor EN-1994-2
126
Fc = Ac
0.85fck
= 1.9484
0.8535
1.50
fck
(EN-1994-2, 2.4.1.2).
127
applied: fcd =
cc fck
. cc takes account of the long term effects on the compressive
c
strength and of unfavourable effects resulting from the way the loads are applied.
The value for cc is to be given in each National annex. EN-1994-2 used the value 1.00,
without permitting national choice for several reasons 1:
-
The plastic stress block for use in resistance of composite sections, defined in
EN-1994, 6.2.1.2 (figure 6.2) consist of a stress 0.85fcd extending to the neutral
axis, as shown in Figs. 6.2 and 6.3.
Fig. 6.2 Rectangular stress blocks for concrete in compression at ULS (figure 2.1 of )
Fig 6.3 Detail of the stress block for concrete al ULS (figure 6.1 of )
-
Predictions using the stress block of EN-1994 have been verified against the
results for composite members conducted independently from the verifications for
concrete bridges.
The EN-1994 block is easier to apply. The Eurocode 2 rule for rectangular block
(EN-1992-1-1, 3.1.7 (3)) was not used in Eurocode 4 because resistance
formulae became complex where the neutral axis is close to or within the steel
flange adjacent to concrete slab.
See Designers Guide to EN-1994-2. Eurocode 4: Design of composite steel and concrete
structures. Part 2: General rules and rules for bridges, C.R. Hendy and R.P. Johnson
128
Fs ,uf = As ,uf
fy ,uf
M0
= (1.0 0.04)
345
1.0
= 13.80 MN
Fs ,w = As ,w
o
fy ,w
M0
= (2.72 0.018)
345
1.0
= 16.891 MN
Fs ,lf = As ,lf
fy ,lf
M0
= (1.20 0.04)
345
1.0
= 16.56 MN
Fig. 6.4 Plastic neutral axis and design of plastic resistance moment at mid span P1-P2
As Fc Fs,uf + Fs,w + Fs,lf
concluded that the PNA is located in the structural steel upper flange at a distance x from the upper
extreme fibre of this flange.
The internal axial forces equilibrium of the cross section leads to the location of the PNA:
Fc Fs ,uf x + Fs ,uf
(0.04 x )
0.04
+ Fs ,w + Fs ,lf = 0
129
This is what usually happens in composite bridges in sagging areas, with cross sections in class 1,
with the PNA near or in the upper concrete slab, or at least in class 2, with only a small upper part of
the compressed web.
As
hw
tw
2.72
0.018
= 151.11
31
fy ,w hw t
3 M 1
Given the distribution of the transverse bracing frames in the span P1-P2 (spacing a = 8 m), a vertical
frame post is located in the studied cross-section (as for the cross-section at support P1). The shear
buckling check is therefore performed in the adjacent web panel with the highest shear force. The
maximum shear force registered in this panel is VEd = 2.21 MN.
As the vertical frame posts are assumed to be rigid:
2
hw
2.72
= 5.802
= 5.34 + 4
8
a
2
k = 5.34 + 4
E =
2 Etw 2
12 1- 2 hw 2
12 1- 0.3 2 2720 2
130
w =
fy ,w
fy ,w
= 0.76
cr 3
cr
= 0.76
345
48.22
= 2.032
w =
1.37
( 0.7 + )
1.37
( 0.7 + 2.032 )
w is:
Finally the contribution of the web to the shear buckling resistance is:
Vbw ,Rd =
w fy ,w hw t
3 M 1
10 = 4.441 MN
-6
fy ,w hw t
3 M 0
So, as VEd = 2.21 MN VRd = min(Vbw,Rd ; Vpl,a,Rd)= min(4.44 ; 11.70)=4.44, then is verified.
6.1.3.3 Bending and vertical shear interaction
According to EN-1994-2, 6.2.2.4 if the vertical shear force VEd does not exceed half the shear
resistance VRd, obtained before, there is no need to check the interaction M, V (Fig. 6.5)
In our case VEd = 2.21<0.54.44=2.22 MN then there is no need to check the interaction M-V.
Fig. 6.5 Shear-Moment interaction for class 1 and 2 cross-sections (a) with shear buckling and
1
without shear buckling (b). (Figure 6.6 of )
131
c=
blf tw
2
1200 26
2
c
t lf
587
120
= 587 mm
= 4.891 9 = 9
235
295
= 8.033
132
Ultimate force of the tensioned upper reinforcing steel bars ( 20/130 mm) (located in the
slab):
Fs ,1 = As ,1
o
fsk
1.15
= 92.797 10 -4 m 2
500
1.15
fy .uf
M0
= (1.2 0.12)
295
1.0
= 35.4 MN
Fs ,w = As ,w
o
500
Fs ,uf = As ,uf
o
= 144.996 10 -4 m 2
Ultimate force of the tensioned lower reinforcing steel bars ( 16/130 mm) (located in the
slab):
Fs ,2 = As ,2
o
fsk
fy ,w
M0
= (2.56 0.026)
345
1.0
= 22.963 MN
Design plastic resistance of the structural steel lower flange (1 lower flange):
Fs ,lf = As .lf
fy ,lf
M0
= (1.20 0.12)
295
1.0
= 42.48 MN
As Fs,1 + Fs,2 + Fs,uf Fs,w + Fs,lf (45.7365.44) and Fs,1 + Fs,2 + Fs,uf + Fs,w Fs,lf (68.7042.48)
the PNA is deduced to be located in the steel web.
If we consider that the P.N.A. is located at a distance x from the upper extreme fibre of the web, then
the internal axial forces equilibrium of the cross-section leads to the location of the PNA:
x
(2.56 x )
Fs,w
Fs,w Fs,lf = 0
2.56
2.56
6.304+4.034+35.4+8.97X-22.963+8.97X-42.48=0 ; X=1.098 m
Over half of the steel web is in compression (the lower part): 2.56-1.098=1.462 m.
hw - x
hw
2.56 - 1.098
2.56
Then, according to EN-1993-1-1, 5.5 and table 5.2 (sheet 1 of 3), if >0.50 then:
133
c
t
2.56
0.026
= 98.46 >>
456
456
235
345
= 58.59
13 1 130.571 1
=
The steel web is at least in Class 3 and reasoning is now based on the elastic stress distribution at
ULS given in Fig. 6.6: = -(268.2 / 253.1) = -1.059 -1 therefore the limiting slenderness between
Class 3 and Class 4 is given by (EN-1993-1-1, 5.5 and table 5.2):
c
t
2.56
0.026
= 98.46 62 (1- ) (- ) = 62
235
345
fy
M0
As we have 292.63 MPa in the upper steel flange and -277.54 MPa in the lower steel flange, which
are below the limit of fy/M0=295MPa admitted in an elastic analysis for the thickness of 120 mm, the
bending resistance is verified.
This verification could be made, not with the extreme fibre stresses, but with the stresses of the center
of gravity of the flanges (EN-1993-1-1, 6.2.1(9)).
6.2.3.2 Alternative: Plastic bending verification (Effective Class 2 cross-section)
EN-1994-2, 5.5.2(3) establishes that a cross-section with webs in Class 3 and flanges in Classes 1 or
2 may be treated as an effective cross-section in Class 2 with an effective web in accordance to EN1993-1-1, 6.2.2.4.
134
Fig. 6.7 Effective class 2 cross-section at support P-1. Design plastic bending resistance
If we consider that the PNA is located at a distance x from the extreme upper fibre of the upper part of
the web, then the internal axial forces equilibrium of the cross section leads to the location of the
PNA:
fy ,w
M0
fy ,w
2 20 tw
Fs,lf = 0
M
0
As
hw
tw
2.56
0.026
= 98.46
31
fy ,w hw t
3 M 1
Given the distribution of the bracing transverse frames (spacing a = 8 m), a vertical frame post is
located in the cross-section at support P1. The shear buckling check is therefore performed in the
adjacent web panel with the highest shear force. The maximum shear force registered in this panel is
VEd = 8.12 MN.
The vertical frame posts are assumed to be rigid. This yields:
135
hw
2.56
= 5.75 is the shear buckling coefficient according to EN-1993 = 5.34 + 4
8
a
2
k = 5.34 + 4
E =
2 Etw 2
12 1 2 hw 2
12 1 0.3 2 2560 2
w =
fy ,w
fy ,w
= 0.76
cr 3
= 0.76
cr
345
112.58
w =
1.37
( 0.7 + )
w
1.37
( 0.7 + 1.33 )
Finally the contribution of the web to the shear buckling resistance is:
Vbw ,Rd =
w fy ,w hw t
3 M 1
10 6 = 8.14 MN
fy ,w hw t
3 M 0
As VEd = 8.12 MN VRd = min(Vbw,Rd ; Vpl,a,Rd)= min(8.14 ; 15.91)=8.14, the shear design force is lower
than the shear buckling resistance.
6.2.3.4 Flange contribution to the shear buckling resistance
When the flange resistance is not fully used to resist the design bending moment, and therefore
MEd<Mf,Rd the contribution from the flanges could be evaluated according to EN-1993-1-5, 5.4.
Vbf ,Rd
bf tf 2fyf MEd
1
=
c M 1 Mf ,Rd
Note that in our case it is not strictly necessary the use of the shear buckling resistance of the flanges,
as seen in the previous paragraph, but we will develop the calculation in an academic way.
Where bf, and tf must be taken for the flange which provides the smallest axial resistance, with the
condition that bf must be not larger than 15tf on each side of the web.
Mf,Rd is the plastic bending resistance of the cross-section neglecting the web area.
136
Fig. 6.8 Design plastic bending resistance neglecting the web area
If we consider that the PNA is located at a distance x from the extreme upper fibre of the upper
flange, then the internal axial forces equilibrium of the cross section leads to the location of the PNA:
Fs ,1 + Fs ,2 + Fs ,uf
x
0.12
Fs ,uf
( 0.12 x )
x
0.12
Fs ,lf = 0
0.12
35.4
( 0.12 x )
0.12
42.48 = 0
Then x =0.1145 m
And the hogging bending moment resistance of the effective cross-section neglecting the web area is:
Mf,Rd=-2(6.304(0.353+0.1145)+4.034(0.13+0.1145)+33.777(0.1145/2)+1.628(0.120.1145)/2+42.48(2.8-0.06-0.1145))= -117.40 MNm.
As MEd = 109.35 < Mf ,Rd = 117.40 , the bending resistance is verified without considering the
influence of the web, and the shear resistance is already verified neglecting the contribution of the
flanges, theres no need no verify the interaction M-V. However we will check the interaction M-V for
the example.
Once the bending resistance of the cross-section neglecting the web Mf,Rd is obtained, the
contribution of the flanges to the shear buckling resistance can be evaluated as:
Vbf ,Rd
bf tf 2fyf MEd
1
=
c M 1 Mf ,Rd
As the upper flange is a composite flange, made of the steel reinforcement and the steel upper flange
itself, we will take the lower steel flange (1200x120 mm2) to evaluate the contribution of the flanges to
the shear buckling resistance
According to EN-1993-1-5, 5.4 (1):
c = a 0.25 +
1.6bf t f 2 fyf
26 2.56 2 345
= 8 0.25 +
thw 2 fyw
137
= 3.110 m
Then:
Vbf ,Rd =
2
1200 1202 295 109.35 6
1
10 = 0.197 MN
117.40
3110 1.1
The shear buckling resistance is the sum of the contribution of the web, Vbw ,Rd = 8.14 MN , obtained
before, and the contribution of the flanges Vbf ,Rd = 0.197 MN , so the total shear buckling resistance in
this case is
Vb,Rd = Vbw ,Rd + Vbf ,Rd = 8.14 + 0.197 14.46 MN ; Vb,Rd = 8.337 MN
The contribution of the flanges to shear buckling resistance represents in this case less than 2.5%,
which could be considered negligible as supposed before.
According to EN-1993-1-5, 5.5, the shear verification is:
3 =
VEd
Vb,Rd
8.12
8.14
M
2
1 + 1 f ,Rd 2 3 1 1.0
M pl ,Rd
Where:
1 =
VEd
MEd
, and 3 =
Vbw ,Rd
M pl ,Rd
Fig. 6.9 Shear-Moment interaction for Class 3 and 4 cross-sections according to clause 7.1 of
1
EN-1993-1-5. (Figure 6.7 of )
138
This criterion should be verified, according to EN-1993-1-5. 7.1 (2) at all sections other than those
located at a distance less than hw/2 from a support with vertical stiffener.
If we consider the internal shear forces and moments of the section located over P-1
(x=60m):VEd=8.124MN, MEd=-109.35mMN, and the section located at X=62.5 m: VEd=7.646MN,
MEd=-91.86mMN, we could obtain the values of the design shear force and bending moment of the
section located at X=61.25 m, which approximately is at hw/2 from the support, as an average of both
values, on the safe side:
Then, we will verify the interaction for the design internal forces and moments:
VEd=(8.124+7.646)/2=7.885 MN, and MEd=(-109.35-91.86)/2=-100.605 mMN
That leads to: 1 =
1 + 1
M f ,Rd
M pl ,Rd
100.605
122.97
= 0.818 ; 3 =
7.885
8.14
= 0.9686 , and:
139
Fig. 6.10 Two examples of road composite bridges with double composite action in hogging
areas
Fig. 6.11 shows a view of Viaduct Arroyo las Piedras in the Spanish High Speed Railway Line
Crdoba-Mlaga. This is the first composite steel-concrete Viaduct of the Spanish railway lines, with a
main span of 63.5 m.
In High Speed bridges the typical twin girder solution for road bridges must improve their torsional
stiffness in order to respond to the high speed railway requirements. In this case, in hogging areas the
double composite action is materialized not only for bending but also for torsion.
The double composite action was extended to the whole length of the deck to allow the torsion circuit
to be closed. A strict box cross section is obtained in sagging areas with the use of discontinuous
precast slabs only connected to the steel girders for torsion and not for bending.
Fig. 6.11 Example of a High Speed Railway Viaduct with double composite action
140
Fig. 6.12 Cross-section at support P-1 with double composite action. Design plastic bending
resistance
2
Back to our case study, if we change the lower steel flange from 1200x120 mm to a smaller one, of
2
1000x60 mm plus a 0.50 m thick bottom slab of concrete C35/45 (Fig. 6.12), we could verify the
bending resistance to compare both cross sections. We could also resize the upper steel flange or
even the upper slab reinforcement, but for this example, we will keep the original ones and only
change the lower steel flange.
Fig. 6.13 shows a classical solution for composite road bridges with double composite action. The
bottom concrete slab, in hogging areas, is extended to a length of 20 or 25% of the main span. The
maximum thickness at support cross section is 0.50 m and the minimum thickness at the end of the
slab is 0.25 m. Fig. 6.13 defines in red line the thickness distribution of the bottom concrete slab, and
in green the lower steel flange reduction.
Fig. 6.13 Alternative steel distribution of the double composite main girder and bottom
concrete slab thickness
141
For the example we are only calculating the ultimate bending resistance of the double composite
cross section at support P-1, but it is necessary to clarify some aspects treated by EN-1994-2 related
to the double composite action.
EN 1994-2, establishes in 5.4.2.2 (2) the modular ratio simplified method for considering the creep
and shrinkage of concrete in a simple composite cross-section. For double composite cross sections
this simplified method is not fully applicable.
EN-1994-2, 5.4.2.2 (10) requires that for double composite cross section with both slabs un-cracked
(e.g. in the case of pre-stressing) the effects of creep and shrinkage should be determined by more
accurate methods.
Strictly speaking, in our case, we do not have double composite action with both slabs un-cracked,
because the upper slab will be cracked, and we will neglect its contribution and only consider the
upper reinforcement, so what we have in hogging areas is a simple composite cross-section with the
reinforcement of the upper slab and bottom concrete in compression.
c=
c
t lf
blf tw
2
487
60
1000 26
= 487 mm
= 8.116 10 = 10
235
335
= 8.375
Ultimate force of the tensioned upper reinforcing steel bars ( 20/130 mm) (located in the
slab):
Fs ,1 = As ,1
o
= 144.996 10 4 m 2
500
1.15
Ultimate force of the tensioned lower reinforcing steel bars ( 16/130 mm) (located in the
slab):
Fs ,2 = As ,2
o
fsk
fsk
= 92.797 10 4 m 2
500
1.15
Fs ,uf = As ,uf
fy .uf
M0
= (1.2 0.12)
295
1.0
= 35.4 MN
142
Fs ,w = As ,w
= (2.62 0.026)
M0
345
1.0
= 23.50 MN
Design plastic resistance of the structural steel lower flange (1 lower flange):
Fs ,lf = As .lf
o
fy ,w
fy ,lf
= (1.00 0.06)
M0
335
1.0
= 20.1 MN
Fc ,inf = Ac
0.85fck
= 3.5 0.5
0.85 35
1.50
= 34.7 MN
As
(45.7378.3)
and
Fs,1 + Fs,2 + Fs,uf + Fs,w Fs,lf + Fc ,inf (69.2354.8) the PNA is located in the steel web.
If we consider that the P.N.A. is located at a distance x from the upper extreme fibre of the web, then
the internal axial forces equilibrium of the cross-section gives the location of the PNA:
Fs ,1 + Fs ,2 + Fs ,uf + Fs ,w
x
2.62
Fs ,w
(2.62 x )
2.62
Fs ,w Fs ,lf Fc ,inf = 0
6.304+4.034+35.4+8.97X-23.5+8.97X-54.8=0; X=1.815 m
Only around 30% of the steel web is in compression (the lower part): 2.62-1.815=0.805 m.
hw x
hw
2.62 1.815
2.62
= 0.307 0.50
Then according to EN-1993-1-1, 5.5 and table 5.2 (sheet 1 of 3), if <0.50 then:
Therefore the limiting slenderness between Class 2 and Class 3 is given by:
c
t
2.62
0.026
= 100.76 <
41.5
41.5
=
235
345
= 111.56
0.307
h *w x
*
hw
2.12 1.815
2.12
= 0.144 0.50
Then according to EN-1993-1-1, 5.5 and table 5.2 (sheet 1 of 3), if <0.50 then:
Therefore the limiting slenderness between Class 1 and Class 2 is given by:
143
c
t
2.12
0.026
= 81.54 <
36
36
=
235
345
= 206.33
0.144
Mpl,Rd=-(6.304(0.353+0.12+1.815)+4.034(0.13+0.12+1.815)+35.4(0.06+1.815)+
16.28(1.185/2) +7.22(0.805/2)+34.72(0.805-0.25)+20.1(0.805+0.06/2))= -142.85 MNm
In comparison with the simple composite action cross-section we have significantly increased the
bending moment resistance, locally reducing the amount of structural steel just by adding the bottom
concrete slab connected to the steel girders.
For the final verification MEd should be lower than the ultimate bending resistance Mpl,Rd. For the
example we havent recalculated the new design bending moment MEd, increased by the self weight
of the bottom concrete, something that of course should had been done in a real case.
144
The appearance of the construction work. This is related with such criteria as high
deflections and extensive cracking, rather than aesthetics.
In this case study we are only analyzing the stress limitation and the cracking of concrete. And we will
not carry out a deflection or vibration control, that should be done according to EN-1994, 7.3.
145
Fig. 6.14 Concrete slab stress under the characteristic SLS combination
Fig. 6.15 Upper reinforcement layer stress under the characteristic SLS combination
146
Unacceptable cracking or deformation may be assumed to be avoided if, under the characteristic
combination of loads, the tensile stress in the reinforcement does not exceed k3fsk, and where the
stress is caused by an imposed deformation, the tensile stress should not exceed k4fsk. k3 and k4 are
nationally determined parameters, and the recommended values are k3= 0.8 and k4= 1.0).
Fig. 6.15 shows the maximum and minimum normal stresses of the upper reinforcement layer of the
slab, calculated in two different hypotheses, upper slab cracked or uncracked under the characteristic
SLS combination. The stress results for all cross-sections of the bridge are widely verified for the
example, very far from both tensile limits 0.8fsk=400 MPa or 1.0fsk=500 MPa.
Note that the stresses calculated with a contributing concrete strength are not equal to zero at the
deck ends because of the shrinkage self-balanced stresses (isostatic or primary effects of shrinkage).
When Mc,Ed is negative, the tension stiffening term s should be added to the stress values in Fig. 5.2
calculated without taking the concrete strength into account. This term s is in the order of 100 MPa
(see paragraph 6.6.3).
Ed ,ser
Ed ,ser
fy
M ,ser
fy
3 M ,ser
fy
M ,ser
The partial factor M,ser is a national parameter, and the recommended value is 1.0 according to EN1993-2, 7.2 (note 2).
Strictly speaking the Von Mises criterion of the third equation only makes sense if it is calculated with
concomitant stress values.
For the verification of the stresses control at SLS, the stresses should be considered on the external
faces of the steel flanges, and not in the flange midplane (EN-1993-1-1, 6.2.1 (9)).
Figs. 6.16 and 6.17 show the maximum and minimum normal stresses of the upper and lower steel
flanges calculated in two different hypotheses, upper slab cracked or uncracked.
The normal stresses for all cross-sections of the bridge are far from the limit of the yield strength,
which depends on the steel plate thickness (Figs. 6.16 and 6.17):
Ed ,ser
fy
M ,ser
147
Fig. 6.16 Upper steel flange stress under the characteristic SLS combination
Fig. 6.17 Lower steel flange stress under the characteristic SLS combination
These figures make it clear that the normal stress calculated in the steel flanges without taking the
concrete strength into account are logically equal to zero at both deck ends. However this is not true
for the stresses calculated by taking the concrete strength into account as the self-balanced stresses
from shrinkage (still called isostatic effects or primary effects of shrinkage in EN1994-2) were then
taken into account.
148
Fig. 6.18 shows the maximum and minimum shear stresses in the centroid of the cross section
calculated in two different hypotheses, upper slab cracked or uncracked. The shear stress results for
all cross-sections of the bridge are very far from the limit:
Ed ,ser
fy
3 M ,ser
355
3 1.0
= 204.96MPa
Fig. 6.18 Shear stress in the centre of gravity of the cross-section under the characteristic
SLS combination
To be safe without increasing the number of stress calculations (and because this criterion is widely
verified for the example, see Figs. 6.19 and 6.20), the Von Mises criterion has been assessed for
each steel flange by considering the maximum normal stress in this flange and the maximum shear
stress in the web (i.e. non-concomitant stresses and hypotheses on the safe side).
Figs. 6.19 and 6.20 show the maximum and minimum stresses applying the Von Mises safety criterion
described in both steel flanges. All cross-sections of the bridge are very far from the limit:
fy
M ,ser
149
Fig. 6.19 Von Mises criterion in the upper flange under the characteristic SLS combination
Fig. 6.20 Von Mises criterion in the lower flange under the characteristic SLS combination
150
fre
1.5fy
M ,ser
This criterion is used to ensure that the "frequent" variations remain confined in the strictly linear part
(+/- 0.75 fy) of the structural steel stress-strain relationship. With this, any fatigue problems for a low
number of cycles are avoided.
hw
tw
30 + 4.0L 300
Generally speaking this criterion is widely verified for road bridges. Otherwise EN1993-2 defines a
more accurate criterion (EN-1993, 7.4 (3)), if EN-1993-2, 7.4 (2) is not satisfied, based on:
o
the critical plate buckling stresses of the unstiffened web (or of the sub-panel):
cr = kE and cr = kE,
o
the stresses x,Ed,ser and x,Ed,ser for frequent SLS combination of actions (calculated at a
particular point where fatigue crack initiation could occur):
2
+
1.1
cr cr
151
According to EN-1992-1-1, 7.31 table 7.1N, for exposure classes XC3 and XC4 the recommended
value of the maximum crack width wmax is 0.3 mm under the quasi-permanent load combination.
We will also verify the crack width, limited to wmax=0.3 mm, under indirect non-calculated actions
(restrained shrinkage), in the tensile zone for the characteristic SLS combination of actions.
is a coefficient which accounts for the effect of non-uniform self balanced stresses. It may be
taken equal to 0.80 (EN-1994-2, 7.4.2 (1)).
ks
is a coefficient which accounts for the effect of the reduction of the normal force of the
concrete slab due to initial cracking and local slip of the shear connection, which may be
taken equal to 0.90 (EN-1994-2, 7.4.2 (1)).
kc
is a coefficient which takes into account the stress distribution within the section immediately
prior to cracking, and is given by:
kc =
1
1 + hc / ( 2z0 )
+ 0.3 1.0
hc
is the thickness of the concrete slab, excluding any haunch or ribs. In our case hc=0.307 m
z0
is the vertical distance between the centroid of the uncracked concrete flange, and the
uncracked composite section, calculated using the modular ratio n0 for short term loading. In
our case, for P-1 cross section, z0=1.02677-(0.109+0.307/2)= 0.764 m, and for the P1/P2 midspan cross-section, z0=0.66854-(0.109+0.307/2)= 0.406 m.
is the maximum stress permitted in the reinforcement immediately after cracking. This may be
taken as its characteristic yield strength fsk (according to EN-1994-2, 7.4.2). In our case
fsk=500 MPa.
Act is the area of the tensile zone, caused by direct loading and primary effect of shrinkage,
immediately prior to cracking of the cross section. For simplicity the area of the concrete
2
section within the effective width may be used. In our case Act=1.95 m .
Then:
kc =
kc =
1
1 + 0.307 / ( 2 0.764 )
1
1 + 0.307 / ( 2 0.406 )
+ 0.3 = 1.13 1.0 for the support P-1 cross-section, hence kc=1.0
+ 0.3 = 1.02 1.0 for the mid-span P-1-P-2 cross-section, hence kc=1.0
As ,min = 0.9 1.0 0.8 3.2 1.950 10 6 / 500 = 8985.6mm 2 = 89.85cm 2 for half of slab (6 m).
152
As we have 20/130 in the upper reinforcement level and 16/130 in the lower reinforcement level,
2
2
the reinforcement area is (24.166+15.466) cm /m6.0m=237.79 cm >> Asmin, so the minimum
reinforcement of the slab is verified.
wk=0.3 mm
wk=0.2 mm
40
32
20
16
12
10
8
6
32
25
16
12
10
8
6
5
25
16
12
8
6
5
4
-
The maximum bar diameter for the minimum reinforcement may be obtained according to EN-19942, 7.4.2 (2):
= *
fct ,eff
fct ,0
Where is obtained of table 7.1 of EN-1994, and fct,0 is a reference strength of 2.9 MPa.
Table 6.2 Maximum bar spacing for high bond bars (EN-1994-2, 7.4.3 table 7.2)
Maximum bar spacing (mm) for design crack width wk
Steel Stresses
s (N/mm2)
wk=0.4 mm
wk=0.3 mm
wk=0.2 mm
160
200
240
280
320
360
300
300
250
200
150
100
300
250
200
150
100
50
200
150
100
50
-
The stresses in the reinforcement should be determined taking into account the effect of tension
stiffening of concrete between cracks. In EN-1994-2, 7.4.3 (3) there is a simplified procedure for
calculating this.
153
In a composite beam where the concrete slab is assumed to be cracked, stresses in reinforcement
increase due to the effect of tension stiffening of concrete between cracks compared with the stresses
based on a composite section neglecting concrete.
The direct tensile stress in the reinforcement s due to direct loading may be calculated according to
EN-1994-2, 7.4.3 (3)
s = s,0 + s
With s =
0.4fctm
AI
and st =
st s
AaIa
Where:
s,0 is the stress in the reinforcement caused by the internal forces acting on the composite
section, calculated neglecting concrete in tension.
fctm is the mean tensile strength of the concrete. For a concrete C35/45 (according to EN-1992-1-1
table 3.1) fctm=3.2 MPa.
s =
As
Act
Act is the area of the tensile zone. For simplicity the area of the concrete section within the
2
effective width may be used. In our case Act=1.95 m .
As
is the area of all layers of longitudinal reinforcement within the effective concrete area.
A, I are area and second moment of area, respectively, of the effective composite section
neglecting concrete in tension.
Aa, Ia are area and second moment of area, respectively, of the structural steel section.
Although there could be another section of the bridge with higher tensile stresses in the
reinforcement, due to the sequence of the concreting phase, we will check for the application example
only two cross sections, over the support P-1, which normally would be the worst section, and mid
span P-1/P-2.
At
the
s =
P-1
cross-section:
237.79 10
As=237.79
cm
20/130
16/130
in
m),
hence
1.95
185.59 10 4
1.95
= 0.00952 .
0.1555 0.2456
0.1369 0.1969
0.3543 0.5832
0.3305 0.5076
= 1.416 .
s =
0.4 3.2
1.232 0.01219
= 85.23MPa
154
0.4 3.2
1.416 0.0
= 94.95MPa
As the tensile stresses in the reinforcement caused by the internal forces acting on the composite
section, calculated neglecting concrete in tension are:
o
Then the direct tensile stresses in reinforcement s due to direct loading (according to EN-1994-2,
7.4.3) are:
o
As both values are below 160 MPa, according to table 6.2, the maximum bar spacing for the design
crack width wk=0.3mm is 300 mm. As we have 130 mm, the maximum bar spacing is verified.
According to table 6.1, the maximum bar diameter * for the minimum reinforcement should be 32
mm, and
= 32
3.2
2.9
= 35.31mm
As the example verifies the minimum reinforcement established by EN-1994-2, 7.4.2 (1), the actual
maximum diameter used in the longitudinal steel reinforcement is 20, lower than the limit
established by EN-1994-2, 7.4.2 (2), and the bar spacing also verifies the limits established by EN1994-2, 7.4.2 (3), then the crack width is controlled.
This gives:
o
-4
-4
High bond bars with diameter = 20 mm have been chosen in the upper reinforcement layer of the
slab at the support cross-section, and = 16 mm at the mid-span P-1/P-2 cross section. This gives:
o
155
The maximum reinforcement stress is obtained by linear interpolation in Table 7.1 in EN1994-2:
o
Rd
is the design resistance when the failure is due to the shear of the steel shank toe of the stud:
P (1)Rd =
0.8fu
d2
4
(2)
P Rd is the design resistance when the failure is due to the concrete crushing around the shank of the
stud:
P ( 2)Rd =
With:
h
h
= 0.2 sc + 1 for 3 sc 4
d
d
= 1.0 for
hsc
>4
d
Where:
fu
is the specified ultimate tensile strength of the material of the stud (fu500MPa).
fck
is the characteristic cylinder compressive strength of the concrete. In our case fck=35 MPa.
Ecm is the secant modulus of elasticity of concrete (EN-1992-1-1, 3.1.2 table 3.1). In our case
0.3
Ecm=22000(fcm/10) =34077.14 MPa. (fcm=fck+8 MPa)
hsc is the overall nominal height of the stud.
156
In our case, if we consider headed studs of steel S-235-J2G3 of diameter d=22 mm, height hsc=200
mm, and fu=450 MPa, then:
P (1)Rd =
hsc
d
200
22
222
4
= 0.1095 10 6 N=0.1095 MN
1.25
0.8 450
= 0.1226 MN
Then: PRd = 0.1095 MN . Each row of 4 headed studs (Fig. 6.21) resist at ULS: 4 PRd = 0.438 MN
For Serviceability State Limit, EN-1994, 7.2.2 (6) refers to 6.8.1 (3). Under the characteristic
combination of actions the maximum longitudinal shear force per connector should not exceed ksPRd
(the recommended value for ks=0.75).
Then: k s PRd = 0.75 0.1095 MN=0.0766 MN . Each row of 4 headed studs (Fig. 6.21) resist at SLS:
4 ks PRd = 0.3064 MN
157
However if we consider the upper flange non-connected to the upper concrete slab, according to EN1993-1-1 table 5.2 sheet 2 of 3, c/tf = ((1000-18)/2)/40=12.275 and that would result a Class 4 flange
as c/t f =12.275>14 =14 235 345 = 11.55
In order to classify a compressed upper flange connected to the slab as a Class 1 or 2 because of the
restraint from shear connectors, the headed studs rows should be sufficiently close to each other to
prevent buckling between two successive rows (EN-1994-2, 6.6.5.5(2)). This gives an additional
criterion in smax :
smax 22t f 235 fy if the concrete slab is solid and there is contact over the full length.
smax 15t f 235 fy if the concrete slab is not in contact over the full length (e.g. slab with transverse
ribs). This is not our case.
Where tf is the thickness of the upper flange, and fy the yield strength of the steel flange.
Table 6.3 summarizes the results of applying both conditions to our case.
Table 6.3 Maximum longitudinal spacing for rows of studs
Upper Steel flange
tf (mm)
fy (N/mm )
smax
eD
40
55
80
120
345
335
325
295
726
800
800
800
297
414
*
*
eD 9 t f 235 fy
Minimum distance between the edge of a connector and the edge of a plate
According to EN-1994-2, 6-6-5-6 (2), the distance eD between the edge of a headed stud and the
edge of a steel plate must not be less than 25 mm, in order to ensure the correct stud welding.
158
bf b0
2
d
2
1000 750
2
22
2
= 114 > 25
d 1.5 t f
This is widely satisfied in the example, with tfmin=55mm in the tensile area, and d=22mm.
This limitation also applies to steel webs. This verification allows the use of the detail category c =
90 MPa.
Clause 6.6.5.7 (5) establishes that the limit for other elements than plates in tension or webs is
d2.5tf
159
6.6.5.4 (2). This value could be reduced to 30 mm if no concrete haunch is used (EN-1994-2 6.6.5.1
(1)) (see Fig. 6.22).
Figs. 6.24 and 6.25 show a general view and a detail of the connection with headed studs of the
upper flange of a composite bridge, and Fig. 6.26 shows the connection of the lower flange of the
main steel girders in a double composite cross-section.
Figs. 6.24 & 6.25 View and detail of an upper flange connection
L ,k =
ScVk
I
160
Where:
L,k is the longitudinal shear force per unit length at the interface concrete-steel
Sc
is the moment of area of the concrete slab with respect to the centre of gravity of the
composite cross-section
Vk
is the shear force for the considered load case and coming from the elastic global cracked
analysis
According to EN-1994-2, 6.6.2.1 (2), to calculate normal stresses, when the composite cross-section
is ultimately (characteristic SLS combination of actions in this paragraph) subjected to a negative
bending moment Mc,Ed, the concrete is taken as cracked and does not contribute to the cross-section
strength. But to calculate the shear force per unit length at the interface, even if Mc,Ed is negative, the
characteristic cross-section properties Sc and I are calculated by taking the concrete strength into
account (uncracked composite behaviour of the cross-section).
The final shear force per unit length is obtained by adding algebraically the contributions of each
single load case and considering the construction phases. As for the normal stresses calculated with
an uncracked composite behaviour of the cross-section, the modular ratio used in Sc and I is the
same as the one used to calculate the corresponding shear force contribution for each single load
case.
For SLS combination of actions, the structure behaviour remains entirely elastic and the longitudinal
global bending calculation is performed as an envelope. Thus the value of the shear force per unit
length is determined in each cross-section at abscissa x by:
L,k ( x )
Ni
(ks PRd ) , with ks PRD = 4 ks PRD, of
Li
1 stud
Where:
L,k is the shear force per unit length in the connection under the characteristic SLS combination
Ni
is the number of rows of 4 headed studs 22mm and h=200 mm located at the length Li
Li
ksPRd=4 ks PRd, of 1 stud =0.3064 MN is the SLS resistance of a row of 4 headed studs, calculated in
7.1
For the example we have divided the total length of the bridge into segments delimited by the
following abscissa x in (m), corresponding with nodes of the design model:
0.0
6.0
12.5
25.0
35.0
42.0
50.0
62.5
80.0
87.5
100.0
108.0
112.5
120.0
132.0
140.0
150.0
162.5
170.0
176.0
187.5
194.0
200.0
161
For example, for the segment [50.0 m ; 62.5 m] around the support P1, the shear force per unit length
obtained in absolute value for characteristic SLS combination of actions is as follows (in MN/m):
Table 6.4 Shear force per unit length at SLS at segment 50-62.5 m
+
x (m)
50
54
54
60
60
62.5
L,k (MN/m)
0.842
0.900
0.900
0.989
0.943
0.906
The maximum SLS shear force per unit length to be considered is therefore 0.989 MN/m, which is
guaranteed providing the stud rows are placed at the maximum spacing of (4 studs per row):
(4k s PRd )
max ( L ,k ( x ) )
0.3064 MN
0.989 MN/m
Fig. 6.27 illustrates this elastic design of the connection for characteristic SLS combination of actions.
The curve representing the shear force per unit length that the shear connectors are able to take up
thus encompasses fully the curve of the SLS design shear force per unit length.
The corresponding values of row spacing, obtained for the design of the connection in SLS are
summarized in paragraph 6.7.5 of this chapter. Note that we have considered regular spacing jumps
from 50 to 50 mm.
Fig. 6.27 SLS shear force per unit length resisted by the headed studs
162
L,Ed =
ScVEd
I
Where:
L,Ed is the design longitudinal shear force per unit length at the concrete-steel interface.
Sc
is the moment of area of the concrete slab with respect to the centre of gravity of the
composite cross-section.
VEd is the design shear force for the considered load case and coming from the elastic global
cracked analysis considering the constructive procedure.
Fig. 6.28 shows the variations in this design longitudinal shear force per unit length for the ULS
combination of actions, for the case of the example.
According to EN-1994-2, 6.6.1.2 (1) the number of shear connectors (headed studs) per unit length,
constant per segment, should verify the following two criteria:
o
locally in each segment i, the shear force per unit length should not exceed by more than
10% what the number of shear connectors per unit length can resist:
L,Ed ( x ) 1.1
Ni
PRD , with PRD = 4 PRD, of
Li
1 stud
Where:
Ni
is the number of rows of 4 headed studs 22mm and h=200 mm located at the length
Li
Li
PRd=4PRd, of 1 stud =0.438 MN is the ULS resistance of a row of 4 headed studs, calculated
in 7.1.
o
over every segment length (Li), the number of shear connectors should be sufficient so that
the total design shear force does not exceed the total design shear resistance:
163
xi+1
L,Ed
1 stud
xi
Where xi and xi+1 designates the abscissa at the border of the segment Li.
For the design of the connection at ULS we have considered the same segment division as used for
the SLS verification.
In the example, for the segment [50.0 m ; 62.5 m] around the support P1, the design shear force per
unit length obtained in absolute value for ULS combination of actions is as follows (in MN/m):
Table 6.5 Design shear force per unit length at ULS at segment 50-62.5 m
+
x (m)
50
54
54
60
60
62.5
L,Ed (MN/m)
1.124
1.203
1.203
1.323
1.264
1.213
The maximum ULS design shear force per unit length to be resisted is therefore 1.323 MN/m, which is
guaranteed providing the stud rows are placed at the maximum spacing of (4 studs per row):
1.1 0.438 MN
1.323 MN/m
= 0.365 m
L ,Ed
xi
(4 PRd , 1 stud )
s
Then s(4PRd, of 1 stud)/1.232= 0.438/1.232=0.355 m, then on the safe side the spacing for this
segment would be s=0.35 m.
Fig. 6.28 illustrates the elastic design of the connection for the Ultimate Limit State (ULS) combination
of actions.
164
Fig. 6.28 ULS shear force per unit length resisted by the headed studs
6.7.4.2 Design with plastic zones in sagging bending areas
If, a cross-section with a positive bending moment at ULS has partially yielded, the previous elastic
calculation, made for the ULS combination of actions, should be supplemented (EN-1994-2, 6.6.2.2
(1)).
As far as the structure behaviour is no longer elastic, the relationship between the shear force per unit
length and the global internal forces and moments is no longer linear. Therefore the previous elastic
calculation becomes inaccurate. In a plastic zone, the shear connection is normally heavily loaded
and a significant bending moment redistribution occurs between close cross-sections.
In our case, although the mid-span cross-sections are Class 1 sections, no yielding occurs, as we can
see on Fig. 6.1, with a medium tensile value for the lower flange of 342.9MPa < fy=345MPa. There is
therefore no need to perform the more complex calculations established by EN-1994-2 in clauses
6.6.2.2 (2) and (3).
165
, shear stress range in the stud shank, calculated at the level of its weld on the upper
structural steel flange.
Unlike normal stress range, the shear stresses at the steel-concrete interface are
calculated using the uncracked cross-section mechanical properties. The shear stress for
the basic combination of non-cyclic loads (EN1992-1-1, 6.8.3) has therefore no influence.
is thus deduced from variations in the shear force per unit length under the FLM3
crossing only noted L,FLM3 by taking account of its transverse location on the
166
pavement and using the short term modular ratio n0. also depends on the local shear
connector density and the nominal value of the stud shank area:
L,FLM 3
d 2 Ni
4 Li
Where:
Ni
is the number of rows of 4 headed studs 22mm and h=200 mm located at the
length Li.
Li
L,FLM3 is the variations in the shear force per unit length under the FLM3 crossing.
o
p, normal stress range in the upper steel flange to which the studs are welded.
E,2 = v
Where:
is the range of shear stress due to fatigue loading, related to the cross-sectional area of the
2
shank of the stud d /4 with d the diameter of the shank.
v
is the damage equivalent factor depending on the spectra and the slope m of the fatigue curve.
For bridges, the damage equivalent factor v for headed studs in shear should be determined from
v= v1v2v3v4 (EN-1994-2, 6.8.6.2 (3))
Factors v2 to v4 should be determined in accordance with EN-1993-2, 9,5,2 (3) to (6) but using
exponents 8 and 1/8 instead of 5 and 1/5, to allow for the relevant slope m=8 of the fatigue strength
curve for headed studs given in EN-1994-2, 6.8.3 (3).
o
v1 is the factor for damage effect of traffic. According to EN-1994-2, 6.8.6.2 (4) v1=1.55
for road bridges up to 100 m span.
Q N
v 2 = m1 obs
Q0 N0
Where:
ni Qi 8
Qm1 =
(EN-1993-2, 9.5.2 (3)) is the average gross weight (kN) of the
ni
1/ 8
167
N0=0.5x10
Nobs is the total number of lorries per year in the slow lane. In this example we have
6
Nobs=0.5x10 , equivalent to a road or motorway with medium rates of lorries (EN1991-2, table 4.5 (n))
Qi is the gross weight in kN of the lorry i in the slow lane.
ni is the number of lorries of gross weight Qi in the slow lane.
Table 6.6 Traffic assumption for obtaining v2
Lorry
Q (kN)
Long.
distance
1
2
3
4
5
200
310
490
390
450
20%
5%
50%
15%
10%
If we substitute table 6.6 values into the previous equations, then we obtain:
Qm1=457.37 kN
v 2 =
o
457.37
= 0.952
480
v3 is the factor for the design life of the bridge. For 100 years of design life, then v3=1.0
according to EN-1993-2, 9.5.2 (5)
v4 takes into account the effects of the heavy traffic on the other additional slow lane
defined in the example. In the case of a single slow lane, v4=1.0.
In the present case, the factor depends on the transverse influence of each slow lane on
the internal forces and moments in the main girders:
N Q 8
v 4 = 1 + 2 2 m 2
N1 1Qm1
1/ 8
1 e
2 b
With
e
is the eccentricity of the FLM3 load with respect to the bridge deck axis (in the
example +/- 1.75 m);
is the distance between the main girders (in the example 7.0 m).
1 =
1 1.75
1 1.75
+
= 0.75 and 2 =
= 0.25
2 7.0
2 7.0
168
The factor 1 represents the maximum influence of the transverse location of the traffic slow
lanes on the fatigue-verified main girder. N1=N2 (same number of heavy vehicles in each slow
lane) and Qm1=Qm2 (same type of lorry in each slow lane) will be considered for the example.
This gives finally v4=1.0.
Then v=1.550.9521.01.0=1.477
For the upper steel plate, a stress range E is defined according to EN-1994-2, 6.8.6.1 (2):
E = max,f min,f
Where:
max,f and min,f are the maximum and minimum stresses due to the maximum and minimum
internal bending moments resulting from the combination of actions defined in EN1992-1-1, 6.8.3 (3):
Gk , j "+ " P "+ " 1,1Qk ,1 "+ " 2,i Qk ,i "+ " Qfat
i >1
j 1
is the damage equivalent factor, calculated according to EN-1993-2, 9.5.2., for road
bridges, with the relevant slope of the fatigue strength curve m=5.
is a damage equivalent impact factor. For road bridges = 1.0 (EN-1994-2, 6.8.6.1
(7)), however is increased when crossing an expansion joint, according to EN1991-2. 4.6.1(6), =1.3[1-D/26]1.0, where D (in m) is the distance between the
detail verified for fatigue and the expansion joint (with D6m).
Ff E 2 c / Mf ,s
Where:
E,2 is the equivalent constant range of shear stress for two millions cycles
is the fatigue partial factor. According to EN-1993-2, 9.3 the recommended value is Ff=1.0
Mf,s is the partial factor for verification of headed studs in bridges. According to EN-1994-2, 2.4.1.2
(6), the recommended value is Mf,s=1.0.
Meanwhile, where the maximum stress in the steel flange to which studs connectors are welded is
tensile under the relevant combination, the interaction at any cross-section between shear stress
range E in the weld of the stud connector and the normal stress range E in the steel flange should
be verified according to EN-1994-2, 6.8.7.2 (2):
169
Ff E,2
Ff E,2
1.0 ;
1.0 and Ff E,2 + Ff E,2 1.3
c / Mf c / Mf ,s
c / Mf ,s
c / Mf
Where:
170
Fig. 6.31 Spacing of the rows of connectors under the fatigue ULS
ACTION ON THE
The shear force per unit length at the steel/concrete interface, used in the previous calculations, only
takes account of hyperstatic (or secondary) effects of shrinkage and thermal actions. It is therefore
necessary to also verify, according to EN-1994-2 6.6.2.4 (1), that sufficient shear connectors have
been put in place at both free deck ends, to anchor the shear force per unit length coming from the
isostatic (or primary) effects of shrinkage and thermal actions.
The first step is to calculate in the cross-section at a distance Lv from the free deck end (anchorage
length) the normal stresses due to the isostatic effects of the shrinkage (envelope of short-term and
long-term calculations) and thermal actions.
Integrating these stresses over the slab area gives the longitudinal shear force at the steel/concrete
interface for the two considered load cases.
The second step is to determine the maximum longitudinal spacing between stud rows over the length
Lv which is necessary to resist the corresponding shear force per unit length. The calculation is
performed for ULS combination of actions only. In this case, EN1994-2, 6.6.2.4 (3) considers that the
studs are ductile enough for the shear force per unit length vL,Ed to be assumed constant over the
anchorage length Lv. This length is taken as equal to beff, which is the effective slab width in the global
analysis at mid-end span (6 m for this example).
All calculations performed for the design example, a maximum longitudinal shear force of 2.15 MN is
obtained at the steel/concrete interface under shrinkage action (obtained with the long-term
calculation) and 1.14 MN under thermal actions.
This therefore gives VL,Ed = 1.0x2.15 + 1.5x1.14 = 3.86 MN for ULS combination of actions.
171
Notice that according to EN-1992-1-1, 2.4.2.1 (1) the recommended partial factor for shrinkage action
is SH=1.0.
The design value of the shear flow L,Ed (at ULS) and then the maximum spacing smax over the
anchorage length Lv= beff between the stud rows are as follows:
L,Ed =
smax =
VL,Ed
beff
4PRd , 1 stud
L,Ed
0.438
0.643
= 0.681 m
This spacing is significantly higher than the one already obtained through previous verifications (see
Fig. 7.9). As it is generally the case, the anchorage of the shrinkage and thermal actions at the free
deck ends does not govern the connection design.
Notes:
o
To simplify the design example, the favourable effects of the permanent loads are not
taken into account (self-weight and non-structural bridge equipments). Anyway they
cause a shear flow which is in the opposite direction to the shear flow caused by
shrinkage and thermal actions. So the suggested calculation is on the safe side.
Note that it is not always true. For instance, for a cross-girder in a cantilever outside the
main steel girder and connected to the concrete slab, the shear flow coming from external
load cases should be added to the shear flow coming from shrinkage and thermal actions.
Finally the shear flow for ULS combination of these actions should be anchored at the
free end of the cross-girder.
EN1994-2, 6.6.2.4(3) suggests that the same verification could be performed by using the
shear flow for SLS combination of actions and a triangular variation between the end
cross-section and the one at the distance Lv. However, this will never govern the
connection design and it is not explicitly required by section 7 of EN1994-2 dealing with
the SLS justifications.
172
References
EN-1992-1-1: Eurocode 2: Design of concrete structures. Part 1-1: General rules and rules for
buildings.
EN-1992-2: Eurocode 2: Design of concrete structures. Part 2: Concrete bridges- Design and
detailing rules.
EN-1993-1-1: Eurocode 3: Design of steel structures. Part 1-1: General rules and rules for buildings.
EN-1993-1-5: Eurocode 3: Design of steel structures. Part 1-5: Platted steel structures.
EN-1993-2: Eurocode 3: Design of steel structures. Part 2: Steel bridges.
EN-1994-1-1: Eurocode 4: Design of composite steel and concrete structures. Part 1-1: General rules
and rules for buildings.
EN-1994-2: Eurocode 4: Design of composite steel and concrete structures. Part 2: General rules and
rules for bridges.
L.Davaine, F. Imberty, J. Raoul. 2007. Guidance book. Eurocodes 3 and 4. Application to steelconcrete composite road bridges.Stra.
C.R. Hendy and R.P. Johnson. 2006. Designers Guide to EN-1994-2. Eurocode 4: Design of
composite steel and concrete structures. Part 2: General rules and rules for bridges. Great
Britain: Thomas Telford.
173
174
CHAPTER 7
Yosra BOUASSIDA
Universit Paris-Est, Ecole des Ponts ParisTech
Navier-CERMES
176
7.1 Introduction
Eurocode 7 deals with all the geotechnical aspects needed for the design of structures (buildings and
civil engineering works). Eurocode 7 should be used for all the problems of interaction of structures
with the ground (soils and rocks), through foundations or retaining structures. It addresses not only
buildings but also bridges and other civil engineering works. It allows the calculation of the
geotechnical actions on the structures, as well the resistances of the ground submitted to the actions
from the structures. It also gives all the prescriptions and rules for good practice required for properly
conducting the geotechnical aspects of a structural project or, more generally speaking, a purely
geotechnical project.
Eurocode 7 consists of two parts:
EN 1997-1 Geotechnical design - Part 1: General rules (CEN, 2004)
EN 1997-2 Geotechnical design - Part 2: Ground investigation and testing (CEN, 2007).
In the following, it is applied to the geotechnical design of the supports for the steel-concrete
composite two-girder bridge, shown in Fig. 7.1 (Davaine, 2010a). Only abutment C0 and pier P1 are
considered, because of the symmetry of the bridge.
177
The selection of appropriate values of soil properties for foundations (or other geotechnical structures)
is probably the most difficult and challenging phase of the whole geotechnical design process and
cannot be extensively described here.
In the Eurocodes procedures, in particular the Eurocode 7 one, characteristic values of these
properties should be determined before applying any partial factor of safety. Fig. 7.4 shows the link
between the two parts of Eurocode 7 and, more importantly, gives the main steps leading to
characteristic values.
The present philosophy with regard to the definition of characteristic values of geotechnical
parameters is contained in the following clauses of Eurocode 7 Part 1 (clause 2.4.5.2 in EN1997-1):
(2)P The characteristic value of a geotechnical parameter shall be selected as a cautious estimate of
the value affecting the occurrence of the limit state.
(7) []the governing parameter is often the mean of a range of values covering a large surface or
volume of the ground. The characteristic value should be a cautious estimate of this mean value.
These paragraphs in Eurocode 7 Part 1 reflect the concern that one should be able to keep using
the values of the geotechnical parameters that were traditionally used (the determination of which is
not standardised, i.e. they often depend on the individual judgment of the geotechnical engineer, one
should confess). However two remarks should be made at this point: on the one hand, the concept of
'derived value' of a geotechnical parameter (preceding the determination of the characteristic value),
has been introduced (see Fig. 7.4) and, on the other hand, there is now a clear reference to the limit
state involved (which may look evident, but is, in any case, a way of linking traditional geotechnical
engineering and the new limit state approach) and to the assessment of the mean value (and not a
local value; this might appear to be a specific feature of geotechnical design which, indeed, involves
'large' areas or 'large' ground masses).
Statistical methods are mentioned only as a possibility:
(10) If statistical methods are employed [], such methods should differentiate between local and
regional sampling [].
(11) If statistical methods are used, the characteristic value should be derived such that the
calculated probability of a worse value governing the occurrence of the limit state under consideration
is not greater than 5%.
NOTE In this respect, a cautious estimate of the mean value is a selection of the mean value of the
limited set of geotechnical parameter values, with a confidence level of 95%; where local failure is
concerned, a cautious estimate of the low value is a 5% fractile.
178
Fig. 7.2 Identification of soils : core sampling results between abutment C0 and pier P1
179
180
Type of test
F= field L= laboratory
F1
Correlations
F2
C1
L1
L2
C2
3
EN 1997-2
EN 1997-1
Information
from other
sources on
the site, the
soils and
rocks and
the project
Cautious selection
The layer from ground level to the base of the foundation is assumed to have :
- unit weight = 20 kN/m .
3
Water level is assumed to be one metre below the foundation level in both cases.
Finally, behind the gravity wall, the fill material is assumed to be a sand of good quality, well
compacted :
- cohesion intercept in terms of effective stress : ckf = 0
- angle of shearing resistance in terms of effective stress: kf = 30
- total unit weight kf = 20 kN/m
181
NGF 51.3m
NGF 44.0m
NGF 38.0m
Fig. 7.5 Gravity wall for abutment CO and shallow foundation for squat pier P1
(all dimensions in metres)
182
Fig. 7.6 Gravity wall for abutment CO and shallow foundation for squat pier P1.
Forces and notations
Designation
C0 (MN)
P1 (MN)
Gk,1
1.1683
5.2867
Gk,2
0.39769
1.4665
3 cm settlement on support P1
Sk
0.060
-0.137
Traffic UDL
Qvk,1 max/min
0.97612/-0.21869
2.693/-0.15637
Traffic TS
Qvk,2 max/min
0.92718/-0.11741
0.94458/-0.1057
To get the maximum value of the vertical support reaction, the nominal value of the support reaction
for the non structural equipments should be multiplied by the coefficient 1.282. The minimum value is
obtained with the coefficient 0.8364.
183
The ULS value of the unfavourable vertical reaction with traffic loads on support is then given by (for
half bridge deck):
Vd,max = 1.35 (Gk,1 + 1.282 Gk,2) + 1.0 Sk + 1.35 (Qvk,1 + Qvk,2)
This leads to 4.89 MN for C0 and 14.45 MN for P1.
The ULS value of the favourable vertical reaction with traffic loads on support is then given by (for
half bridge deck):
- for abutment C0 : Vd,min = Gk,1 + 0.8364 Gk,2 + 1.35 (Qvk,1, + Qvk,2) = 1.047 MN
- for pier P1 :
max
Braking :
-0.90658
MN
Acceleration :
0.90658
MN
7.3.1.3 Horizontal wind action effects (Malakatas, 2010 and Davaine 2010c)
The following values are extracted from Malakatas (2010)
Fwk,1 = 1310 kN (or qwk,1 = 1310kN / 200m = 6.55 kN/m) transversally and horizontally applied to the
bridge deck without traffic loads
Fwk,2 = 2066 kN (or qwk,2 = 10.33 kN/m) with traffic loads
230 kN applied to the 10-m-high piers
For simplifications, the wind effects on piers are neglected in the foundation calculations.
According to Fig. 7.7, the transverse displacements of the bridge are prevented. The transverse
horizontal wind is then applied to a continuous 3 span girder. For simplifications, this girder is
assumed having a constant second moment of area.
Thus the transverse horizontal variable actions Hykw due to wind are given in Table 7.2 (Davaine,
2010c).
184
60 m
80 m
60 m
North
7m
C0
South
P1
P2
C3
Fig. 7.7 Displacement conditions of the bridge (Davaine, 2010b and 2010c)
Table 7.2 Transverse horizontal variable actions Hykw due to wind (Davaine, 2010c)
Transverse horizontal force Hy
due to:
C0
P1
141 kN
514 kN
223 kN
810 kN
185
Combination 1 (DA1-1) is called the structural combination because safety is applied on the actions
(i.e. partial load factors F larger or equal to 1.0) and the design value of the geotechnical resistance
Rd is equal to the value of the characteristic resistance.
Combination 2 (DA1-2) is called the geotechnical combination because the safety is applied on the
geotechnical resistance Rd, through partial material factors M larger than 1.0, applied at the source
to the ground parameters themselves. No safety is applied on unfavourable permanent (structural or
geotechnical) actions. Note that for the resistance of piles and anchors resistances factors R are
used instead of material factors M.
Thus, for DA1-1 (with the recommended values given in Note 2 of Table A2.4 (B) of EN 1990, for Eq.
6.10) :
Ed {FFrep} Rd {Xk}
with G,sup = 1.35; G,inf = 1.00; G,set = 1.35; 1.20 or 0; and Q = 1.20 to 1.50 or 0
and for DA1-2 (with the recommended values given in the Note of Table A2.4 (C) of EN 1990 for Eq.
6.10):
Ed {FFrep} Rd {Xk/M}
with G,sup = 1.00; G,inf = 1.00; G,set = 1.00 or 0; and Q = 1.15 to 1.30 or 0
Table 7.3 summarises the recommended values of load factors used for DA1-1 (set A1) and DA1-2
(set A2).
Table 7.3 Partial factors on actions (F) or the effects of actions (E)
(table A.3 in EN 1997-1)
Action
Permanent
Symbol
Unfavourable
Favourable
Variable
Unfavourable
Favourable
Set
A1
A2
1.35
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.5
1.3
For DA1-2, the recommended values for the partial factors M both for geotechnical actions and
resistances are those of set M2 given in Table 7.4 (except for resistances of piles and anchors).
186
Table 7.4 Partial factors for soil parameters(M) (table A.4 in EN 1997-1)
Soil parameter
Symbol
Set
M1
M2
1.0
1. 5
Effective cohesion
1.0
1.25
cu
1.0
1.4
Unconfined strength
qu
1.0
1.4
Weight density
1.0
1.0
Ed {FFrep} Rd {Xk}/R
- for DA2 *:
Symbol
Set
R1
R2
R3
Bearing
R;v
1.0
1.4
1.0
Sliding
R;h
1.0
1.1
1.0
187
Table 7.6 Partial resistance factors (R) for retaining structures (table A.13 in EN 1997-1)
Resistance
Symbol
Set
R1
R2
R3
Bearing capacity
R;v
1.0
1.4
1.0
Sliding resistance
R;h
1.0
1.1
1.0
Earth resistance
R;e
1.0
1.4
1.0
Combination: (A1* or A2 ) + M2 + R3
188
7.4 Abutment C0
7.4.1 BEARING CAPACITY (ULS)
The ULS condition is (Eq. 6.1 in EN 1997-1):
Fvd Rd
(1)
where
- Fvd is the design value of the vertical component acting on the base of the foundation, coming from
structural and geotechnical actions on the abutment;
- Rd is the design value of the resistance of the ground (bearing capacity) below the base of the
foundation.
Structural actions
From the governing structural loads given above, the following design loads are derived for each
Design Approach in permanent and transient design situations.
Vertical:
- for DA1-1 and DA2 and DA3 :
Vd
- for DA1-2 :
Vd
Horizontal X :
- for DA1-1, DA2 and DA3 :
- for DA1-2 :
Horizontal Y :
- for DA1-1, DA2 and DA3 :
- for DA1-2 :
Geotechnical actions
The additional and geotechnical actions to be taken into account are :
- the weight of the gravity wall and its foundation, which is derived from geometrical data shown in
Figs. 7.5, 7.6 and 7.8, with 1 m of ground above all the surface of the spread foundation, a sloping
3
ground on its lateral walls and filled up inside the lateral walls, using = 25 kN/m for the concrete and
3
= 20 kN/m for the ground:
Gwall,k = 26.4 MN
Thus,
for DA1-1 and DA2 and DA3 :Gwall,d = 1.35 x 26.4 = 35.64 MN
(note that for DA3, Gwall is considered as a structural action, as it is a weight composed of ground and
concrete above the base of the foundation)
and
for DA1-2 :
Gwall,d = 26.4 MN
- resulting active earth pressures on the virtual back of the wall, and as there is no water:
Pad = G,sup x 0.5 Kad kfh2La
(2)
where Kad is the design active earth pressure coefficient, assuming sufficient wall displacement; for a
horizontal pressure (no inclination is assumed):
189
(3)
(theory of Rankine; see also Fig. C.1.1 in Annex C for EN 1997-1 for a horizontal retained surface and
making = 0) and h2 = 9.8 m and La = 12 m are the height and length (in the perpendicular plane)
over which the active earth pressure applies, respectively see Figs. 7.5 and 7.6. In this calculation it
is assumed that the movement of the ground (at the level of the virtual back) is large enough to
mobilise the active pressure (Annex C.3 of EN 1997-1 give some guidance).
Thus,
- for
DA1-1
and
DA2
df = kf = 30 ; Kad
Pad = 1.35 x 3 .84 = 5.18 MN
0.333
kd = kf = 20
kN/m
and
- for DA1-2 and DA3, considering =1, 25 in Table 4: tan df = (tan kf)/1.25 = tan 30/1.25 and df =
24.8; Kad = 0.409 and
Pad = 1.00 x 4.71 = 4.71 MN
Resultant actions
At the centre of the base of the foundation, the resultant actions are :
Fv = V + Gwall
Fx = Hx + Pa
F y = Hy
My = Pa(h2/3) + Hxh1 Gwalld1 + Vd2
Mx = Hyh1
with h1 = 6.5 m ; d1 = 0.4 m and d2 = 2.95 m - see Figs 7.5 and 7.6.
190
eB = My/Fv
eL = Mx/Fv
and
(4)
Rd = R / R;v
(5)
For DA1-1 :
dg = kg = 30
Fvd = 9.88 + 35.64 = 45.52 MN
Fxd = 2.43 + 5.18 = 7.61 MN
Fyd = 0.20 MN
R;v = 1.0
dg = kg = 30
Fvd = 9.88 + 35.64 = 45.52 MN
Fxd = 2.43 + 5.18 = 7.61 MN
Fyd = 0.20 MN
R;v = 1.4
191
(1)
This condition is fulfilled for all Design Approaches (for permanent and transient design situations)
with a large overdesign factor. For DA1, it can be seen that combination 2 (DA1-2) is governing. DA3
is the most conservative approach, with regard to the ULS of bearing capacity.
Furthermore, it can be noted that all eccentricities are small: the maximum is eB = 1.21 m (DA 1-2) for
width B = 10 m. Thus, there are no special precautions to be taken, as required by clause 6.5.4 of EN
1997-1 in case e > (B or L) /3. The eccentricities in L direction are negligible, and it appears that the
transverse wind loads have nearly no influence on the bearing capacity of abutment C0.
(6)
where
- Fxd is the design value of the horizontal component of the load acting in the longitudinal direction on
the base of the foundation, coming from structural and geotechnical actions on the abutment see
above for values in persistent transient design situations;
- Rd is the sliding resistance and Rp;d is the passive earth force in front of the spread foundation.
For drained conditions the sliding resistance Rd is (Eqs. 6.3a and 6.3b in EN 1997-1) :
Rd = {Fvd (tank)/M}/R;h
(7)
where
- Fvd is the design value of the favourable effective vertical force. In the present case, it is equal to the
total one Finf,vd, as the water table is at the level of the foundation; hence the pore pressure u = 0 at
the level of the base of the foundation);
d is the concrete-ground interface friction angle; it is usually assumed that k = 2/3 kg, i.e. k = 20
and tank = 0.364;
- M and R;h are taken from the recommended values in Tables 7.4 and 7.6 respectively, for each
Design Approach in persistent and transient design situations.
Actions
Fvd = Vd,min + Gwall,d
- for DA1-1, DA2 and DA3 : Vd,min = Gk,1+0.8364 Gk,2+1.35(Qvk,1+ Qvk,2) =1.047 x 2 = 2.09 MN
- for DA1-2
192
DA2
DA3
Sliding resistances
DA1-1 : M = 1.0 and R;h = 1.0, thus Rd = {28.49 x 0.364/1.0} /1.0 = 10.37 MN
DA1-2 : M = 1.25 and R;h = 1.0, thus Rd = {28.63 x 0.364/1.25}/1.0 = 8.33 MN
DA2
DA3
ULS-sliding condition
Thus the ULS sliding condition (Eq. 6) is verified, without recourse to the passive force in front of the
spread foundation Rp;d for all Design Approaches for persistent and transient design situations.
Horizontal X :
- DA2 : Hxd = 1.35 ( Qxk,1 + Qxk,2) = 1.35 x 0,91 x 2 = 2.45 MN
Horizontal Y :
- DA2 : Hyd = 1.5 x 0.6 Fwk,2 = 1. 5 x 0.6 x 0.81 = 0.73 MN
The additional action to be taken into account is the weight of the pier, spread foundation and ground
above the foundation. From the geometrical data shown in Fig. 7.5, 7.6 and 7.9 and using = 25
3
3
kN/m for the concrete and = 20 kN/m for the ground:
Gpier,k = 8.3 MN
Thus, for DA2 : Gpier,d = 1.35 x 8.3 = 11.2 MN
193
eB = My/Fv
eL = Mx/Fv
For DA2 :
The resistance R (bearing capacity) is calculated with the sample method of Annex D of EN 1997-1
(CEN, 2004) see Appendix C below. In the present case, R takes the same form as above, for the
abutment C0 (drained conditions are assumed, and ckg= 0).
(8)
194
- B = 7.5 m; L = 10 m; q = 60 kPa; = 10 kN/m (in order to be on the safe side, it is assumed that
the water can reach the level of the base of the foundation);
3
- = dg = 30, the design value of the angle of friction of the bearing stratum (calcareous marl) (for
DA2 : dg = kg = 30);
- the design loads Fvd, Fxd and Fyd, as well as hp = 11.5 m, for the calculations of eB, eL, iq, s and i;
one obtains, for DA 2 : eB= 0.70 m, eL = 0.21 m
Rk = 100.9 MN and Rd = Rk/R;v = 100.9/1.4 = 72.1 MN
and
The ULS condition in permanent and transient design situation Fvd Rd is fulfilled, as
40.1 MN < 72.1 MN.
When comparing Rk to Fvk (10.66 x 2 + 8.3 = 29.62 MN) the overall factor of safety is equal to F =
3.41; it can be said that the usual capacity SLS criterion is also met (F = 2.5 to 3).
2B
s = ( q - v0 ) 0
9 Ed
B B
d + c
9 Ec
B0
(9)
Here:
- q = 0.18 MPa
- vo = q = 60 kPa
- B= 7.5 m
- L/B = 1.33, thus d = 1.26 and c = 1.13
- normally fractured rock : = 0.5
The Mnard pressuremeter moduli are the following (from Fig. 7.3; D is the depth of the base of the
foundation) :
- from D to D+B/2 :
E1 = 7.3 MPa
E4 = 20.0 MPa
195
E5 = 30.0 MPa
Thus,
Ec = E1 = 7.3 MPa
and Ed is determined by the harmonic mean of Ei (I from 1 to 16), taking account of the distribution of
the vertical stress from depth D + B/2 to D+ 8B (see MELT, 1993); when E6 to E16 E5 , an
approximation is :
with
(10)
(11)
0.5
/(9x14.65) + 0.5x1.13x7.5/9x7.3]
0.5
/(9x6) + 0.5x1.13x7.5/9x6]
196
1998-5 are cu = 1.4, tcy = 1,25, qu = 1.4, and = 1.25. They correspond to the ones recommended
by EN 1997-1 for persistent and transient design situations (see set M2 in Table 7.4). Some countries
(Greece, for instance) have judged that these values are much too severe, given the safety already
included in the calculations of the seismic design values of the action effects. Their National Annex
have thus set them all equal to 1.0 (as well as alternative resistance factors R).
197
REFERENCES
CEN 2002. Eurocode: Basis of structural design. EN 1990 : 2002. European Committee for
Standardization (CEN): Brussels.
CEN 2004. Eurocode 7: Geotechnical design - Part 1: General rules. EN 1997-1:2004 (E), November
2004, European Committee for Standardization: Brussels.
CEN 2005. Eurocode 8: Design of structures for earthquake resistance - Part 5: Foundations,
retaining structures and geotechnical aspects. EN1998-5:2004 (E), May 2005, European
Committee for Standardization: Brussels.
CEN 2007. Eurocode 7: Geotechnical design - Part 2: Ground investigation and testing. EN19972:2007 (E), March 2007, European Committee for Standardization: Brussels.
Davaine L. 2010a. Global analysis of a steel-concrete composite two-girder bridge according to
Eurocode 4, Note for Workshop Bridge design to Eurocodes to be held in Vienna, 4-6 October
2010, June 2010, 39 pages.
Davaine L 2010b. Excel sheet with a synthesis of the reactions and supports, e-mail to TC 250/HGB :
June 09, 2010 6:24 pm.
Davaine L. 2010c. Supplement for support reactions, Private written communication, Workshop
Bridge design to Eurocodes, Vienna, 4-6 October 2010, June 2010, 16 August 2010, 2 pages.
Kolias B. 2010a. Squat piers with seismic isolation. Summary of seismic design results. Note for
Workshop Bridge design to Eurocodes to be held in Vienna, 4-6 October 2010, June 2010, 25
pages.
Kolias B. 2010b. Flexible piers with limited ductile behaviour. Summary of seismic design results.
Note for Workshop Bridge design to Eurocodes, Vienna, 4-6 October 2010, July 2010, 14
pages.
Malakatas N. 2010. Example of application for Wind actions on bridge deck and piers, Report for
Workshop Bridge design to Eurocodes, Vienna, 4-6 October 2010, January 2011, 20 pages.
MELT-Ministre de l'Equipement, du logement et des transports 1993. Rgles Techniques de
Conception et de Calcul des Fondations des Ouvrages de Gnie Civil (in French: Technical Rules
for the Design of Foundations of Civil Engineering Structures). Cahier des clauses techniques
gnrales applicables aux marchs publics de travaux, FASCICULE N62 -Titre V, Textes
Officiels N 93-3 T.O., 182 pages.
198
CHAPTER 8
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
200
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
8.1 Introduction
This chapter covers an overview of seismic issues for bridge design, in accordance with EN 19982:2005 and EN 1998-1:2004, developed along the lines of a general example, common for the
application of Eurocodes 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 7 and 8.
The general example is a bridge having composite steel and concrete continuous deck, with spans of
60 + 80 + 60 m. Two cases are assumed for the piers namely, 40 m high hollow cylindrical piers and
10 m high, solid rectangular piers. Regarding the seismic design situation, neither of these bridge
configurations offers itself for a seismic load resisting system consisting of piers rigidly fixed to the
deck, with ductile seismic behaviour. However a large part of EN 1998-2 deals with exactly this kind of
seismic load resisting systems, as it is usually cost effective for bridges of relatively shorter spans and
medium total length. To cover the main seismic issues of this important category of bridges, a special
example of such a bridge is also included in this chapter.
Consequently this chapter contains following examples:
o
Section 8.2 - Example of ductile piers: Special example of seismic design of a bridge with
concrete deck rigidly connected to piers designed for ductile behavior.
Section 8.3 - Example of limited ductile piers: Seismic design of the general example:
Bridge on high piers designed for limited ductile behavior.
Section 8.4 - Example of seismic isolation: Seismic design of the general example: Bridge
on squat piers designed with seismic isolation.
It should be noted that the contents of the examples, although selected to illustrate the main seismic
issues regulated by EN 1998-2, do not exhaust all relevant requirements of the standard, and do not
cover of course all issues to be dealt by a real structural design.
201
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
A1
M2
M1
A2
A1
M2
M1
202
A2
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Piers
The value of piers effective stiffness for seismic analysis is estimated initially and is checked after the
selection of the required reinforcement for the piers.
For both piers the stiffness is assumed to be 40% of the uncracked stiffness.
Deck
The uncracked bending stiffness of the prestressed concrete deck is considered. The torsional
stiffness considered is the 50% of the uncracked stiffness.
8.2.2.3 Design seismic action
The design seismic action is calculated by a response spectrum of type 1. The ground type is C, so
the characteristic periods are TB = 0.20s, TC = 0.60s and TD = 2.50s, while the soil factor is S = 1.15.
The bridge is located at seismic zone Z1 with a reference peak ground acceleration agR = 0.16g. The
importance factor is I = 1.0 and the lower bound factor is = 0.20.
The seismic action in horizontal directions is:
ag = agR = 1.0 x 0.16g = 0.16g.
.
203
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
The behaviour factors are, according to 8.2.2.1, qx = 3.5 in longitudinal direction and qy = 3.5 in
transverse direction. The design response spectrum that results from all the above is calculated
according to EN 1998-1:2004, 3.2.2.5 and is presented in Fig. 8.4.
0.900
0.821
0.800
0.767
0.700
velocity
acceleration
displacement
0.600
Sd(T) / ag
0.500
0.400
0.300
0.200
0.100
TB
0.000
0.00
TC
TD
0.50
1.00
1.50
2.00
2.50
3.00
Period, T (s)
Fig. 8.1 Design response spectrum
8.2.2.4 Permanent load for the design seismic situation
Fig. 8.2 Dead, additional dead and uniform traffic load application
The loads applied in the bridge deck (Fig. 8.5) for the seismic situation are:
1. Self weight (G):
2
where the area of the voided section is 6.89m , the area of the solid section is 9.97m , the total length
of the voided section is 73.5m and the total length of the solid section is 9.0m.
(road pavement)
= 43.65kN/m
2
Where the area of the sidewalks is 0.50m /m, the weight of the safety barriers is 0.70kN/m and the
width and thickness of the pavement are 7.5m and 0.10m respectively.
204
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
3. Effective seismic live load (LE). The effective seismic live load is 20% of the uniformly distributed
traffic load:
qL = 45.2kN/m and
.
4. Temperature action (T)*. The temperature action consists of an increase of +52.5 C and a
o
o
decrease of -45 C relative to the construction temperature T0 = 10 C
The assumed effective moment of inertia of piers is Jeff/Jun = 0.40 (remains to be checked later).
Assuming both ends of the piers fixed and for concrete grade C30/37 with Ecm = 33GPa, the
horizontal stiffness of each pier in longitudinal direction is:
3
T =2
m
K
2
=
19250kN / 9.81m / s
57800kN / m
1.16s
=
205
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
The seismic moments My (assuming full fixity of pier columns at top and bottom) are:
My1 V1 H1/2 = 713kN x 8.0m / 2 = 2852kNm
.
206
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Period
No.
X dir
Y dir
Z dir
1.77
3.39
1.43
94.8
1.20
99.19
0.32
8.92
0.32
0.34
0.19
0.72
0.17
0.05
0.01
0.15
63.13
0.14
10
0.10
11
0.10
12
0.093
0.01
13
0.069
14
0.058
0.01
15
0.054
10.77
16
0.053
0.16
17
0.052
1.81
18
0.051
0.45
19
0.050
0.02
20
0.047
21
0.040
22
0.036
23
0.035
24
0.032
0.07
25
0.031
26
0.030
0.19
0.23
27
0.029
0.09
28
0.028
0.02
5.39
29
0.028
0.07
30
0.027
0.14
0.06
207
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
nd
st
th
rd
th
th
5 mode (T=0.32s)
6 mode (T=0.19s)
th
th
7 mode (T=0.17s)
208
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Multimode response
spectrum analysis
1.16s
1.20s
rd
(3 mode)
M1
M2
713kN
596kN
662kN
556kN
M1
M2
2852kNm
2533kNm
26052672kNm
23272381kNm
(values at top and bottom)
Effective Period
Teff for
lontitudinal
direction
Seismic shear,
Vz
Seismic
moment, My
My
Mz
As
kN
kNm
kNm
cm
maxMy + Mz
-7159
4576
-1270
198.7
minMy + Mz
-7500
-3720
1296
134.9
maxMz + My
-7238
713
4355
172.4
minMz + My
-7082
456
-4355
170.0
The required reinforcement at the bottom section of Pier M1, which is critical, is 198.7cm . The final
2
reinforcement selected is 2532 (201.0cm ) as shown in Fig. 8.8. Fig. 8.9 shows the Moment Axial
force interaction diagram for the bottom section of Pier M1 for all design combinations.
209
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
-30000
Section with 2532
-25000
-20000
-15000
N (KN)
Design combinations
-10000
-6000
-4000
-5000
-2000
0
0
2000
4000
6000
5000
10000
15000
M (KNm)
Fig. 8.4 Moment Axial force interaction diagram for the bottom section of Pier M1
Table 8.4 shows the design action effects of bending moment and axial force at the bottom section of
pier M2 together with the required reinforcement, for each design combination.
Table 8.4 Design action effects & required reinforcement in bottom section of pier M2
N
My
Mz
As
kN
kNm
kNm
cm
maxMy + Mz
-7528
3370
-1072
103.2
minMy + Mz
-7145
-4227
1042
168.0
maxMz + My
-7317
-465
3324
89.8
minMz + My
-7320
-674
-3324
92.5
Combination
210
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
The required reinforcement in bottom section of Pier M2, which is critical, is 168.0cm . The final
2
reinforcement selected is 2132 (168.8cm ) as shown in Fig. 8.10. Fig. 8.11 shows the Moment
Axial force interaction diagram for the bottom section of Pier M2 for all design combinations.
-30000
N (KN)
-15000
Design combinations
-10000
-6000
-4000
-5000
-2000
0
0
2000
4000
6000
5000
10000
M (KNm)
Fig. 8.6 Moment Axial force interaction diagram for the bottom section of Pier M2
8.2.5.2 Checking of stiffness of ductile elements
The effective stiffness of piers for seismic action is estimated according to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009,
Annex C.
The pier is of circular section with diameter D = 1.20m and is made of concrete C30/37 with
fck=30MPa and Ec=33000MPa and reinforcing steel S500 with fyk=500MPa. The cover to the
reinforcement centre is c=8.2cm.
211
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Pier M1
The final reinforcement for pier M1 is 1 layer of 2532 (201.0cm ). For axial force
N = -7200kN the yield moment is My = 4407kNm and the corresponding concrete strain is
cy = 2.72. The ultimate moment is MRd=4779kNm.
2
-1
while the approximation for circular section according to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, Eq. (C.6) yields
y = 2.4sy/d = 2.4 x 2.17/(1.2m-0.082m) = 4.66.10 m
-3
-1
-3
-1
Jeff/Jun = 0.38
-1
Jeff/Jun = 0.39
The assumed value of Jeff/Jun = 0.40 was a good starting value for the analysis.
Pier M2
For pier M2 the final reinforcement is 1 layer of 2132 (168.8cm ). For axial force
N = -7200kN the yield moment is My = 4048kNm, the corresponding concrete strain is
cy = 2.73 and the ultimate moment is MRd=4366kNm. Method 1 yields:
2
Jeff/Jun = 0.35
while method 2 yields:
Jeff/Jun = 0.36
The assumed value of Jeff/Jun = 0.40 was a good starting value for the analysis.
8.2.5.3 Shear verification of piers
The over strength moment is calculated by Mo = o MRd, where o is the over strength factor and MRd is
the ultimate moment provided by the section analysis. Since k = 0.22 > 0.1 the over strength factor is
increased according to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 5.3(4) by the factor:
.
212
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
The capacity shear forces can be calculated directly from the over strength moments:
VC1 = 2Mo1/H1 = 2x6643/8.0 = 1661kN and
VC2 = 2Mo2/H2 = 2x6069/8.5 = 1428kN
The base shear on each pier is calculated applying the simplifications of EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009,
G.2 and Eq. (G.3):
VCi = (Mo/MEi) VEi
The seismic moment and shear force are:
ME1 = 3061kNm and VE1 = 680.3kN
ME2 = 2184kNm and VE2 = 450.2kN
The capacity effects for the base of the piers are shown for the transverse direction in Fig. 8.12.
VC2=1251kN
Mo2=6069kNm
Mo1=6643kNm
VC1=1476kN
The design is performed according to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 5.6.3.4. The design shear force for
pier M1 is VC1 = 1661kN. For circular section according to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 5.6.3.3(2) the
effective depth is:
de = r + 2 rs/ = 0.60 + 2 x 0.52 / = 0.93m
.
213
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
where Asw is the total cross section of the shear reinforcement, s is the hoop spacing, fywd is the
design yield strength of the shear reinforcement, cot = 1, according to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009,
5.6.3.4(2)P, being the angle between the concrete compression strut and the pier axis and Bd is an
additional safety factor for which Bd = 1.0 according to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 5.6.3.3(1)P.
For pier M1 the required shear reinforcement is:
2
Accordingly for pier M2 the shear design force is VC2 = 1428kN and the required shear reinforcement
is:
2
Confinement reinforcement
For ductile behaviour: = 0.37 and w,min = 0.18. The longitudinal reinforcement ratio for pier M1 is:
L = 201.0cm /11300cm = 0.0178,
2
The distance to spiral centreline is c = 5.8cm (Dsp = 1.084m) and the core concrete area is
2
Acc=0.923m .
The required mechanical reinforcement ratio w,req for pier M1 is:
w,req = (Ac/Acc) k+0.13 (fyd/fcd) (L-0.01) =
(1.13/0.923) x 0.37 x 0.22+0.13 x (500/1.15)/(0.85 x 30/1.5) x (0.0178-0.01) = 0.126,
while for pier M2 is:
w,req = (1.13/0.923) x 0.37 x 0.22+0.13 x (500/1.15)/(0.85 x 30/1.5) x (0.0149-0.01) = 0.116.
For circular spirals the mechanical reinforcement ratio (for the worst case of pier M1) is:
wd,c = max(1.4 w,req; w,min) = max(1.4 x 0.126; 0.18) = 0.18.
.
214
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
sL
The provisions of EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 6.2.2 are applied for the check of the required
transverse reinforcement to avoid buckling of the longitudinal bars.
For S500 steel the ratio ftk/fyk = 1.15.
The maximum hoops spacing sL should not exceed dbL, where
.
Substituting, we get:
req
sL
Confinement
Buckling of
bars
Shear design
At/sL
2
(cm /m)
2x19.0=38
M1: 45.5
M2: 39.1
maxsL
(cm)
19.2
16.4
The transverse reinforcement is governed by the shear design. The reinforcement selected for both
2
piers is one spiral of 16/8.5 (47.3cm /m).
8.2.5.6 Capacity verifications of the deck
The general procedure for calculating the capacity effects, given in EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, G.1,
consists of adding, to the effects of permanent loads G ,the effects of the loading AC = Mo-G, both
acting in the deck-piers frame system of the bridge. An alternative procedure is to work on a
continuous beam system of the deck, simply supported on the piers and abutments. On this system
the effects of the permanent loads G and the effects of the over strength moments Mo are added.
The equivalence of the two procedures is shown in Fig. 8.13.
215
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Permanent Load G
G
MG1
MG2
MG1
MG2
(2)
(1)
MG1
MG2
MG1
MG2
MG1
MG2
MG1
MG2
MO2-MG2
MO2-MG2
MO2-MG2
MO2
MO1
MO1
MO2
MO1
MO2
M (kNm) 2195
2430
2285
2340
216
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Mo1=6643kNm Mo2=6069kNm
M (kNm)
3692
4296
3104
4491
6069
6643
6069
6643
V (kN)
187.4
(-)
256.7 263.8
(+) 1661
161.9
(+) 1428
Fig. 8.10 Over strength for seismic action in +x direction (Mo loading) and resulting moment
and shear force diagrams
M (kNm)
6122
6491
764
2206
6643
6643
6069
6069
(+) 1661
(+) 1428
Fig. 8.11 Capacity effects for seismic action in +x direction (G + M o) and resulting moment
and shear force diagrams
217
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
The deck section at each side of the joints connecting the deck with the piers is checked against
these capacity effects taking into account the existing reinforcement and tendons as shown in Fig.
8.17.
4 groups of 3
tendons of type
DYWIDAG 6815
(area of
2250mm2 each)
Table 8.6 shows the design combinations (moment and axial force) for which the deck sections are
checked, while Fig. 8.18 shows the Moment Axial force interaction diagram compared with the
capacity effects.
Table 8.6 Design combinations for deck section
Combination / location
My (kNm)
N (kN)
-6122
-29900
2206
-28300
-6491
-29500
764
-28100
1262
-28100
-6776
-29500
2101
-28300
-5444
-29900
-200000
Design combinations
-150000
N (KN)
-100000
-50000
-60000
-40000
-20000
20000
40000
50000
M (KNm)
Fig. 8.13 Moment Axial force interaction diagram for deck section
218
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
The verification of pier deck joints should be performed according to EN 19982:2005+A1:2009, 5.6.3.5. This verification is not presented here. It is usually critical for the
shear reinforcement of joints over slender pier columns monolithically connected to the deck.
N=7371kN
Vz=1661kN
My=6643kNm
X
Y
Fig. 8.14 Capacity effects on the foundation of pier M1 for the longitudinal direction (seismic
actions in x direction)
N=7371kN
Vz=730kN
My=124kNm
Vy=1476kN
Mz=6643kNm
Fig. 8.15 Capacity effects on the foundation of pier M1 for the transverse direction
219
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
220
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Fig. 8.19 Minimum reaction forces in bearings for seismic combination (kN)
The bearings maximum vertical reaction forces are presented in Fig. 8.25 with total maximum value
2447kN.
221
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Fig. 8.20 Maximum reaction forces in bearings for seismic combination (kN)
8.2.6.2 Overlapping length
According to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 6.6.4 the minimum overlapping (seating) length at moveable
joints is:
222
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
lov
Clearance of
roadway joint
Approach slab
Structure
clearance
dG
dT
dE
dEd,J
dEd
opening
+18.7
-10.7
+76.0
+54.5
+100.7
closure
-8.5
-76.0
-34.7
-80.3
109.9
44.0
109.9
Transverse
Fig. 8.28 shows the selected roadway joint type and the displacement capacities for each direction.
223
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
It is noted that EN 1998-2 does not contain a minimum reinforcement requirement (see however
8.4.8.2 9 (b) of the last example}.
For the bridge of this example min= 1% as was required, by the owner. The longitudinal reinforcement
of the piers is derived from the seismic demands and is over the minimum requirement (L = 1.78%
for pier M1 and L = 1.49% for pier M2).
224
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Articulated
Articulated
Sliding Longitudinal,
A ti l t d T
The connection of the deck to both pier heads can be articulated (hinge) about the transverse
axis, without causing excessive restraints due to imposed deck deformations
The large flexibility of the seismic forces resisting system corresponds to large values of the
fundamental period in both horizontal directions and therefore to quite low seismic response
spectral accelerations. For such low seismic response levels it is neither expedient nor cost
effective to design the piers for increased ductility. Therefore a limited ductile behavior is
selected, corresponding to a value of the behavior factor q = 1.50, according to Table 4.1 of
EN 1998-2
225
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
0.7
Acceleration (g)
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
0
0.5
1.5
2.5
3.5
4.5
5.5
Period (sec)
Fig. 8.30 EC8 Design Spectrum for horizontal components for q = 1.50
226
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
227
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
75000.0
70000.0
Bottom Section
65000.0
60000.0
Top Section
55000.0
Moment (kNm)
50000.0
45000.0
=1%
40000.0
35000.0
30000.0
25000.0
20000.0
15000.0
10000.0
N=-15000kN
5000.0
N=-20000kN
6.00E-03
5.00E-03
4.00E-03
3.00E-03
2.00E-03
1.00E-03
0.00E+00
0.0
Curvature
75000.0
N=-15000kN
70000.0
65000.0
N=-20000kN
Bottom Section
60000.0
50000.0
45000.0
40000.0
=1%
35000.0
30000.0
25000.0
Top Section
20000.0
15000.0
10000.0
5000.0
1.00
0.90
0.80
0.70
J/Jgross
0.60
0.50
0.40
0.30
0.20
0.10
0.0
0.00
Moment (kNm)
55000.0
Fig. 8.33 Moment - () /(EI) ratio Curve of Pier Section for =1%
eff
228
95000.0
90000.0
85000.0
80000.0
75000.0
70000.0
65000.0
60000.0
55000.0
50000.0
45000.0
40000.0
35000.0
30000.0
25000.0
20000.0
15000.0
10000.0
5000.0
0.0
Top Section
=1.5%
N=-15000kN
6.00E-03
5.00E-03
4.00E-03
3.00E-03
2.00E-03
1.00E-03
N=-20000kN
0.00E+00
Moment (kNm)
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Curvature
95000.0
90000.0
N=-15000kN
85000.0
N=-20000kN
Bottom Section
80000.0
75000.0
70000.0
Moment (kNm)
65000.0
60000.0
55000.0
50000.0
=1.5%
45000.0
40000.0
35000.0
30000.0
25000.0
20000.0
Top Section
15000.0
10000.0
5000.0
1.00
0.90
0.80
0.70
J/Jgross
0.60
0.50
0.40
0.30
0.20
0.10
0.00
0.0
Fig. 8.35 Moment - () /(EI) ratio Curve of Pier Section for = 1.5%
eff
8.3.3.4 Eigenmodes
The characteristics (period and modal mass % in the three principal directions) of the first 30
eigenmodes of the structure are shown Table 8.8. The shapes of modes 1, 2, 3 and 11 are presented
in Figures 8.36, 8.37, 8.38 and 8.39 respectively.
229
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
No
Period
Sec
5.03
3.84
92.5%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
76.8%
0.0%
1.49
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.79
0.0%
0.0%
1.2%
0.71
0.0%
0.5%
0.0%
0.66
0.0%
8.4%
0.0%
0.52
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.50
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.48
0.0%
2.1%
0.0%
10
0.46
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
11
0.42
0.0%
0.0%
63.2%
12
0.42
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
13
0.37
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
14
0.35
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
15
0.26
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
16
0.26
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
17
0.26
0.0%
6.2%
0.0%
18
0.26
4.4%
0.0%
0.0%
19
0.23
0.1%
0.0%
0.0%
20
0.20
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
21
0.20
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
22
0.18
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
23
0.16
0.0%
0.0%
5.0%
24
0.16
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
25
0.16
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
26
0.15
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
27
0.15
0.0%
3.0%
0.0%
28
0.13
0.0%
0.0%
8.8%
29
0.13
0.0%
0.2%
0.0%
30
0.12
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
97.1%
97.2%
78.3%
230
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
st
Fig. 8.36 1 Mode - Transverse Period 5.02 sec c (Mass Participation Factor Ux:93%)
nd
Fig.8.37 2
231
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
rd
Fig. 3.39 11th Mode - Vertical Period 0.42sec (Mass Participation Factor Uz:63%)
8.3.3.5 Response spectrum analysis
A response spectrum analysis considering the first 30 modes was carried out, using program SAP
2000. The sum of the modal masses considered amounts to 97.1% and 97.2% in the X and Y
directions respectively. The combination of modal responses was carried out using the CQC rule.
Fig. 8.40 shows the max bending moment distribution along pier P1.
232
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
1 2
i =0 ah =
200 l
Where: l is the length or height
where lo is the
effective length:
Longitudinal direction x:
Transversal direction y:
The first and second order effect of these eccentricities under permanent load (G), including the creep
effect (for = 2.0), is approximated, using the nominal stiffness method, by the following expression
(see b.i. below):
1+
)
v-1
NB
, NB is the buckling load and ED is the axial force (see b.i. below, according to 5.8 of
NED
233
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Direction
ei
= /ED
ei,II /ei
ei,II
0.063
19.65
1.161
0.073
0.032
78.62
1.039
0.033
for abutments C0 and C3 at the midpoint between the bearings at their level
Ex
Earthquake in x direction
Ey
Earthquake in y direction
234
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
First and second order effects (including creep) of geometric pier imperfections
The action effects of earthquake actions correspond to the response spectrum analysis under the
design spectrum (i.e. the elastic spectrum divided by q = 1.50).
According to 5.5(2) of EN 1998-2, force effects due to imposed deformations need not be included in
the seismic design combinations.
Table 8.10 Pier Top Displacements dEd
Pier Top Displacements for:
dx (m)
dy (m)
Ex+0.3Ey
0.373
0.065
Ey+0.3Ex
0.110
0.197
Table 8.11 Action effects for the design of piers and abutments: q = 1.50 (Eff. Stiffness = 30%)
Pier
Loading
Fx
Fy
Fz
Mx
My
Mz
kN
kN
kN
kN-m
kN-m
kN-m
P1
5.4
-0.2
19539.3
6.8
216.9
-0.2
P2
-5.4
-0.2
19539.3
6.8
-216.9
0.2
C0
0.0
0.2
3505.2
-0.4
0.0
0.0
C3
0.0
0.2
3505.2
-0.4
0.0
0.0
P1
Ex+0.3Ey
1254.4
187.4
28.8
7885.5
50803.5
342.8
P2
Ex+0.3Ey
1254.4
187.4
28.8
7885.5
50803.5
342.8
C0
Ex+0.3Ey
0.0
322.2
21.5
1134.3
0.0
0.0
C3
Ex+0.3Ey
0.0
322.2
21.5
1134.3
0.0
0.0
Sum:
2508.8
1019.1
P1
Ey+0.3Ex
376.3
624.6
8.6
26285.1
15241.0
1142.5
P2
Ey+0.3Ex
376.3
624.6
8.6
26285.1
15241.0
1142.5
C0
Ey+0.3Ex
0.0
1073.9
6.4
3781.1
0.0
0.0
C3
Ey+0.3Ex
0.0
1073.9
6.4
3781.1
0.0
0.0
Sum:
752.6
3397.1
P1
1254.4
187.4
28.8
8153.6
58576.4
342.8
P2
Ex+0.3Ey+2nd Ord.(EC2)
1254.4
187.4
28.8
8153.6
58576.4
342.8
P1
Ey+0.3Ex+2nd Ord.(EC2)
376.3
624.6
8.6
27178.8
17572.9
1142.5
P2
Ey+0.3Ex+2nd Ord.(EC2)
376.3
624.6
8.6
27178.8
17572.9
1142.5
235
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Loading
Fx
Fy
Fz
Mx
My
Mz
kN
kN
KN
kN-m
kN-m
kN-m
P1
Ex+0.3Ey+2nd Ord.(EC8)
1254.4
187.4
28.8
9279.0
58298.5
342.8
P2
Ex+0.3Ey+2nd Ord.(EC8)
1254.4
187.4
28.8
9279.0
58298.5
342.8
P1
Ey+0.3Ex+2nd Ord.(EC8)
376.3
624.6
8.6
30508.3
17451.4
1142.5
P2
Ey+0.3Ex+2nd Ord.(EC8)
376.3
624.6
8.6
30508.3
17451.4
1142.5
0.067
0.017
P1
1254.4
187.4
28.8
9826.3
59393.1
342.8
P2
Ex+0.3Ey+2nd Ord.(EC8)+imperf
1254.4
187.4
28.8
9826.3
59393.1
342.8
P1
Ey+0.3Ex+2nd Ord.(EC8)+Imperf
376.3
624.6
8.6
31055.6
18546.0
1142.5
P2
Ey+0.3Ex+2nd Ord.(EC8)+Imperf
376.3
624.6
8.6
31055.6
18546.0
1142.5
P1
G+Ex+0.3Ey+2nd Ord.(EC8)+Imperf
1259.8
187.2
19568.0
9833.1
59610.0
342.5
P2
G+Ex+0.3Ey+2nd Ord.(EC8)+imperf
1249.1
187.2
19568.0
9833.1
59176.2
343.0
C0
G+Ex+0.3Ey
0.0
322.3
3526.6
1134.0
0.0
0.0
C3
G+Ex+0.3Ey
0.0
322.3
3526.6
1134.0
0.0
0.0
P1
G+Ey+0.3Ex+2nd Ord.(EC8)+Imperf
381.7
624.4
19547.9
31062.4
18762.9
1142.3
P2
G+Ey+0.3Ex+2nd Ord.(EC8)+Imperf
371.0
624.4
19547.9
31062.4
18329.1
1142.7
C0
G+Ey+0.3Ex
0.0
1074.1
3511.6
3780.8
0.0
0.0
C3
G+Ey+0.3Ex
0.0
1074.1
3511.6
3780.8
0.0
0.0
236
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Table 8.12 Action effects for the design of the foundation: q = 1.00 (Eff. Stiffness = 30%)
Pier
P1,P2
C0,C3
Loading
Fx
Fy
Fz
Mx
My
Mz
kN
kN
KN
kN-m
kN-m
kN-m
G+Ex+0.3Ey+2nd
Ord.(EC8)+Imperf
1887.0
280.9
19582.4
13775.8
85011.7
513.9
G+Ey+0.3Ex+2nd
Ord.(EC8)+Imperf
569.8
936.7
19552.2
44204.9
26383.4
1713.5
G+Ex+0.3Ey
0.0
483.4
3537.4
1701.1
0.0
0.0
G+Ey+0.3Ex
0.0
1611.1
3514.8
5671.3
0.0
0.0
Vertical
direction Z
Transverse
direction Y
Mz
My
Longitudinal
direction X
Fz
Mx
Fx
Fy
Fig. 8.41 Direction of forces Fx, Fy, Fz and moments Mx, My, Mz with positive sign for
foundation design
237
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
40000
30000
=1.5%
20000
=1.0%
10000
0
-10000
-20000
-30000
-40000
-50000
-60000
-70000
-80000
-90000
-100000
-110000
-120000
-130000
80000
70000
60000
50000
40000
30000
20000
10000
-140000
Moment (kNm)
Fig. 8.42 Design Interaction Diagram of Pier Base Section
8.3.4.2 Shear
According to 5.6.2 of EN1998-2:2005, the design action effect shall be multiplied by q (= 1.5) and the
resistance values VRd,c, VRd,s, VRd,max derived by 6.2 of EN1992-1-1:2004 shall be divided by Bd1 (=
1.25). Therefore:
CRd ,c =
de = r +
2 rs
= 2.0 +
0.18
0.18
= 0.12
1.5
2 1.8
k = 1+
200
200
= 1+
= 1.25
d
3150
k1 = 0.15
cp =
NEd
15
=
= 3.32
4.52
Ac
238
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
VRd ,c = [0.12 1.25 (100 0.015 35)1/3 + 0.15 3.32] 0.80 3.15 1000 = 2670kN
v Rd ,c
Bd 1
2670
= 2136kN > 18872 + 2812 = 1908kN (no shear reinforcement
1.25
required)
Confining Reinforcement
According to 6.2.1.4 of EN1998-2:2005 the minimum amount of confining reinforcement shall be for
limited ductile:
w ,req =
4.52
19580
500000 1.5
0.28
+ 0.13
(0.015 0.01) = 0.058
3.39
35000 4.52
35000 1.15
w = w
fyd
Ac
0.28 k + 0.13
( l 0.01) =
Acc
fcd
Dsp Asp
fcd
35000 1.15
16 / 11
= 0.12
= 0.0064 and w =
Acc sl
fyd
500000 1.5
In order to avoid buckling of longitudinal compression reinforcement the longitudinal bars along the
external pier face should be restrained, according to 6.2.2(2) of EN 1998-2, by transverse
reinforcement consisting of circular hoops at a spacing sL < 5dbL = 14 cm (satisfied).
It is however noted that along the inside face of the hollow pier the provision of circular transverse
bars is not in general sufficient to prevent buckling of compressed longitudinal reinforcement; as such
bars do not offer tensile hoop action. In case that compressive yield of this reinforcement is reached
under the seismic action (which is not the case in this example), the provision of the minimum amount
of transverse ties, as specified by 6.2.2(3) and (4) for straight boundaries, is necessary..
239
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
U2
U3
R1
R2
R3
Radians
Radians
Radians
Max
-0.007
0.001
0.003
0.001
0.000
0.015
Min
-0.007
-0.001
-0.003
-0.001
-0.001
-0.014
M1a
Max
-0.006
0.000
0.009
0.003
0.000
0.005
M1a
Min
-0.008
0.000
-0.010
-0.003
-0.001
-0.004
M1b
Max
-0.007
0.001
0.000
0.001
0.001
0.015
M1b
Min
-0.007
-0.001
0.000
-0.001
0.000
-0.014
M1b
Max
-0.006
0.000
0.001
0.003
0.003
0.005
M1b
Min
-0.008
0.000
-0.001
-0.003
-0.002
-0.004
A1a
Max
-0.002
0.396
0.000
0.001
0.001
0.003
A1a
Min
-0.002
-0.380
0.000
-0.001
-0.001
0.002
A1a
Max
-0.001
0.126
0.001
0.005
0.002
0.003
A1a
Min
-0.002
-0.111
-0.001
-0.005
-0.002
0.002
A1b
Max
-0.002
0.396
0.000
0.001
0.001
0.003
A1b
Min
-0.002
-0.380
0.000
-0.001
-0.001
0.002
A1b
Max
-0.001
0.126
0.001
0.005
0.002
0.003
A1b
Min
-0.002
-0.111
-0.001
-0.005
-0.002
0.002
Bearing
Combination
M1a
M1a
V2
V3
KN
KN
KN
Max
-6658.87
674.191
Min
-7271.258
-668.901
M1a
Max
-6273.436
374.961
M1a
Min
-7656.692
-369.671
M1b
Max
-6658.976
674.256
159.055
M1b
Min
-7271.362
-668.836
-158.737
M1b
Max
-6273.543
375.025
529.812
M1b
Min
-7656.795
-369.606
-529.494
A1a
Max
-1531.503
173.98
A1a
Min
-1973.792
-187.313
A1a
Max
-1095.842
595.489
A1a
Min
-2409.453
-608.821
A1b
Max
-1531.398
187.129
A1b
Min
-1973.687
-174.115
A1b
Max
-1095.739
608.582
A1b
Min
-2409.347
-595.567
Bearing
Combination
M1a
M1a
240
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Practically equal and therefore minimized action effects on the two piers. This would be achieved
even if the piers had unequal heights.
The additional damping offered by the isolators keeps the displacements to a cost effective level.
241
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
242
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
243
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
direction with non-linear frictional force displacement relation. The approximate bearing dimensions
are: at piers 1.20 m x 1.20 m plan, 0.40 m height, and at abutments 0.90 m x 0.90 m plan, 0.40 m
height. The layout of the seismic isolation bearings is presented in Fig. 8.45, where X is the
longitudinal direction of the bridge and Y is the transverse direction. The label of each bearing is also
shown.
Plan:
C0_L
P1_L
P2_L
C3_L
C0_R
P1_R
P2_R
C3_R
TM
Friction Pendulum bearings are sliding devices with a spherical sliding surface. They consist of an
articulated slider coated with a controlled low friction special PTFE material. Sliding occurs on a
concave stainless steel surface with radius of curvature in the order of 2 m. The coefficient of friction
at the sliding interface is very low, in the order of 0.05 ~ 0.10 and can be reduced even more with
244
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
application of lubrication. The combination of low friction and restoring force due to the concave
surface provides the bearing with bilinear hysteretic behaviour.
The behaviour of sliding devices with a spherical sliding surface is presented in EN 19982:2005+A1:2009, 7.5.2.3.5(2). In Fig. 8.47 the force-displacement relation is shown. The behaviour
consists of the combined effect of:
a) A linear elastic component which provides restoring force corresponding to stiffness Kp = Nsd /
Rb due to the spherical sliding surface with radius Rb, where Nsd is the normal force thought
the device,
b) A hysteretic frictional component which provides force at zero displacement F0 =dNsd and
dissipated energy per cycle ED = 4dNsddbd at cyclic displacement dbd, where d is the dynamic
coefficient of friction of the sliding interface.
The maximum force Fmax and the effective stiffness Keff at displacement dbd are:
Fmax =
( )
N sd
d + d N sd sign d&bd ,
Rb bd
Rb
dbd
K eff =
N sd d N sd
+
Rb
dbd
Nsd
Fmax
Force F
Fmax
p=Nsd/Rb
F0=dNsd
dbd
Displacement d
Ed
Forcedisplacement loop
for seismic
analysis
Fig. 8.47 Friction force-displacement behaviour of a sliding device with a spherical sliding
surface
Certain special features of sliding devices with a spherical sliding surface are worth mentioning:
The horizontal reaction is proportional to the vertical force of the isolator. This means that the
resultant horizontal reaction passes approximately through the centre of mass. No
eccentricities appear.
245
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
As both the horizontal reactions and the inertia forces are proportional to the mass the period
and the seismic motion characteristics are independent of the mass.
The Triple FPS bearing has a more complex sliding behaviour which offers an adaptive seismic
performance and smaller bearing dimensions. The inner isolator consists of an inner slider that slides
along two inner concave spherical surfaces. The two slider concaves, sliding along the two main
concave surfaces, comprise two more independent spherical sliding isolators. Depending on the
friction coefficient of the sliding interfaces and the radii of the spherical surfaces sliding occurs at
different interfaces as the magnitude of displacement increases. Properties of the second sliding
response are typically chosen to minimize the structure shear forces that occur during the design
basis earthquake. Properties of the third sliding response are typically chosen to minimize bearing
displacements that might occur at extreme events. This is characterized as the adaptive behaviour.
The force-displacement relationship is presented in Fig. 8.48.
(b)
(c)
(a)
Adaptive behaviour
l (c)
stiffening,
Effective dynamic friction coefficient: d = 0.061 (+/- 16% variability of nominal value)
246
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
*W p
*W p
sliding
sliding
Articulated
connection
Articulated
connection
247
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
supports, friction forces equal to *Wp, should also be introduced, where is either the minimum or
the maximum value of friction, with opposite signs on the deck and the supporting element, and
directions compatible to the corresponding sliding deformation at the support, as shown in the
following Fig. 8.50. Both displacements and forces can be derived from these systems.
Sliding
Sliding
Articulated
connection
Sliding
248
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Period TD = 2.5 s
According to the note in EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 7.4.1 the value of the period TD is particularly
important for the safety of bridges with seismic isolation because it affects proportionally the estimated
displacement demands. For this reason the National Annex to this part of Eurocode 8 may specify a
value of TD specifically for the design of bridges with seismic isolation that is more conservative
(longer) than the value ascribed to TD in the National Annex to EN 1998-1:2004. For this particular
example the selected value is TD = 2.5 s, which is longer than the value TD = 2.0 s which is
recommended in EN 1998-1:2004, 3.2.2.2(2)P.
For the vertical direction the vertical elastic response spectrum specified in EN 1998-1:2004, 3.2.2.3 is
used. The project dependent parameters that define the vertical response spectrum are selected for
this particular example as follows:
o
Ratio of design ground acceleration in the vertical direction to the design ground acceleration
in the horizontal direction: avg / ag = 0.90
The design spectra for horizontal and vertical directions are illustrated in Fig. 8.51 and Fig. 8.52
respectively.
249
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
1.40
Damping 5%
Spectral acceleration (g)
1.20
1.00
0.80
0.60
0.40
0.20
0.00
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
Period (sec)
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
1.40
Damping 5%
Spectral acceleration (g)
1.20
1.00
0.80
0.60
0.40
0.20
0.00
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
Period (sec)
2.0
2.5
3.0
250
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
component, as presented in Table 8.15. Each component ACC01 to ACC14 and ACV01 to ACV07 is
selected from simulated accelerograms that are produced by modifying natural recorded events so as
to match the Eurocode 8 design spectrum (semi-artificial accelerograms). The modification procedure
consists of applying unit impulse functions that iteratively correct the accelerogram in order to better
match the target spectrum. Analytical description of selected initial records, the modification
procedure and the produced semi-artificial accelerograms is presented in Appendix D.
Table 8.15 Components of ground motions
Ground Motion
Horizontal component in
longitudinal direction
Horizontal component in
transverse direction
Vertical component
EQ1
ACC01
ACC02
ACV01
EQ2
ACC03
ACC04
ACV02
EQ3
ACC05
ACC06
ACV03
EQ4
ACC07
ACC08
ACV04
EQ5
ACC09
ACC10
ACV05
EQ6
ACC11
ACC12
ACV06
EQ7
ACC13
ACC14
ACV07
8.4.3.3 Verification of ground motion compatibility with the design response spectrum
The compatibility of the ground motions EQ1 to EQ7 with the design response spectra is verified in
accordance with EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 3.2.3. For the produced semi-artificial accelerograms that
are used in this work no scaling of the individual components is required to ensure compatibility
because each component is already compatible with the corresponding design spectrum due to the
applied modification procedure presented in Appendix D.
The consistency of the ensemble of ground motions is verified for the horizontal components in
accordance with EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 3.2.3(3)P:
a) For each earthquake consisting of a pair of horizontal motions, the SRSS spectrum is
established by taking the square root of the sum of squares of the 5%-damped spectra of
each component.
b) The spectrum of the ensemble of earthquakes is formed by taking the average value of the
SRSS spectra of the individual earthquakes of the previous step.
c) The ensemble spectrum shall be not lower than 1.3 times the 5%-damped elastic response
spectrum of the design seismic action, in the period range between 0.2T1 and 1.5T1, where T1
is the effective period (Teff) of the isolation system.
The consistency of the ensemble of ground motions is verified for the vertical components in
accordance with EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 3.2.3(6):
d) The spectrum of the ensemble of earthquakes is formed by taking the average value of the
vertical response spectra of the individual earthquakes.
e) The ensemble spectrum shall be not lower than 1,1 times the 5%-damped elastic response
spectrum of the design seismic action, in the period range between 0,2TV and 1,5TV, where
TV is the period of the lowest mode where the response to the vertical component prevails
over the response to the horizontal components (e.g. in terms of participating mass).
The aforementioned consistency criteria are presented graphically in Fig. 8.53 and Fig. 8.54 for
horizontal and vertical components respectively. It is verified that the selected accelerograms are
consistent with the design spectrum of EN 1998-2 for all periods between 0 and 5 s for horizontal
components and for all periods between 0 and 3 s for vertical components. Therefore consistency is
251
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
established for all isolation systems with effective period Teff < 5s / 1.5 = 3.33s and prevailing vertical
period TV < 3 s / 1.5 = 2 s, which are fulfilled for the isolation system of the presented example.
2.00
1.80
1.60
Damping 5%
1.40
1.20
1.00
0.80
0.60
0.40
0.20
0.00
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
Period (sec)
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
Fig. 8.53 Verification of consistency between design spectrum and spectrum of selected
accelerograms for horizontal components.
1.40
1.20
Damping 5%
1.00
0.80
0.60
0.40
0.20
0.00
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
Period (sec)
Fig. 8.54 Verification of consistency between design spectrum and spectrum of selected
accelerograms for vertical components.
252
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Bridge Model
For the purpose of non-linear time-history analysis the bridge is modelled by a 3D model that
accurately accounts for the spatial distribution of stiffness and mass of the bridge. The geometry of
the bridge is accurately modelled. The superstructure and the substructure of the bridge are modelled
with linear beam finite elements with properties in accordance with the actual cross-section of the
elements. The mass of the elements is considered lumped on the nodes of the model. The
discretization of the finite elements is adequate to account for the actual distribution of the bridge
mass. Where necessary kinematic constraints where applied to establish proper connection of the
elements. Non-linear time-history analysis was carried out in computer program SAP2000. In Fig.
8.55 the model of the bridge for time-history analysis is shown.
Isolator model
The Triple FPS bearings are modelled with non-linear hysteretic friction elements. The isolator
elements connect the deck and pier nodes at the locations of the corresponding bearing. In the SAP
2000 model the behaviour of the isolator elements in the horizontal direction follows a coupled
frictional law based on the Bouc-Wen model. In the vertical direction the behaviour of the isolators
corresponds to stiff support that acts only in compression. The actual vertical load of the bearings at
each time instant is taken into account to establish the force-displacement relation of the bearing. The
effects of bridge deformation and vertical seismic action are taken into account in the estimation of
vertical bearing loads.
253
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Foundation flexibility
For the purpose of this example the effect of the foundation flexibility is ignored. The piers are
assumed fixed at their base.
The effective pier stiffness is derived from the uncracked section stiffness of the gross concrete crosssection and the secant modulus of elasticity Ecm = 34 GPa for C35/45 concrete. Because the stiffness
of the piers is much larger than the effective stiffness of the isolation system its contribution to the
total effective stiffness of the structure may be ignored without significant loss of accuracy. This
approach is followed in the fundamental mode analysis which is presented with analytical hand
calculations. In the non-linear time-history analysis which is carried out with computer calculation the
effect of pier stiffness is included.
8.4.4.2 Bridge loads applicable for seismic design
Permanent loads
In Table 8.16 the distribution of the permanent reactions of the deck supports is provided, according
to the provided data of the general example. The time variation of the permanent reactions due to
creep & shrinkage is very small. Because of this small variation only one distribution of permanent
reactions is considered in this example, which is selected as the distribution after creep & shrinkage
become fully developed.
Table 8.16 Permanent loads
Total
support
loads in
MN (both
beams)
Self weight
after
construction
Minimum
equipment
load
Maximum
equipment
load
Total with
minimum
equipmen
t
Total with
maximum
equipment
Time
variation due
to creep &
shrinkage
C0
2.328
0.664
1.020
2.993
3.348
-0.172
P1
10.380
2.440
3.744
12.819
14.123
0.206
P2
10.258
2.441
3.745
12.699
14.003
0.091
C3
2.377
0.664
1.019
3.041
3.396
-0.126
Sum of
reactions
25.343
6.209
9.528
31.552
34.871
0.000
According to the provided data of the general example, the longitudinal displacements due to
permanent actions are approximately 8mm for abutments and 3mm for piers, both towards the center
of the bridge.
According to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 4.1.2 for the case of road bridges with severe traffic the quasi
permanent value 2,1Qk,1 of the traffic action to be considered in the seismic combination is calculated
from the UDL system of traffic Load Model 1 (LM1). For bridges with severe traffic (i.e. bridges of
motorways and other roads of national importance) the value of the combination factor 2,1 is 0.2.
The division of the carriageway in 3 notional lanes in accordance with EN1991-2, 4.2.3 is shown in
Fig. 8.56.
254
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Lane Number 1:
Lane Number 2:
Lane Number 3:
2
2
C0
0.201
P1
0.739
P2
0.739
C3
0.201
Sum of reactions
1.880
255
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
The weight Wd of the deck in seismic combinations includes the permanent loads and the quasipermanent value of the traffic loads:
Wd = Dead load + quasi-permanent traffic load = 34871 kN + 1880 kN = 36751 kN
Thermal action
The minimum ambient air temperature (mean return period of 50 years) to which the structure is
subjected is assumed to be equal to Tmin=-20C. The maximum ambient air temperature (mean return
period of 50 years) to which the structure is subjected is assumed to be equal to Tmax =+40C. The
initial temperature is assumed equal to T0 = +10C.
The uniform bridge temperature components Te,min and Te,max are calculated from Tmin and Tmax using
EN1991-1-5, Figure 6.1 for Type 2 deck type (i.e. composite deck).
The ranges of the uniform bridge temperature component are calculated as:
o
In accordance with EN 1991-1-5, 6.1.3.3(3) Note 2 for the design of bearings and expansion joints the
temperature ranges are increased as follows:
o
General
The nominal values of the design properties (DP) of the isolators as presented in 4.1 are:
o
Effective dynamic friction coefficient: d = 0.061 (+/- 16% variability of nominal value)
The nominal properties of the isolator units, and hence those of the isolating system, may be affected
by ageing, temperature, loading history (scragging), contamination, and cumulative travel (wear). This
variability is accounted for in accordance with EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 7.5.2.4(2)P, by using two
sets of design properties of the isolating system:
o
Upper bound design properties (UBDP), which typically lead to larger forces governing the
design of the structural elements of the bridge, and
Lower bound design properties (LBDP), which typically lead to larger displacements governing
the design of the isolators.
In general two analyses are performed, one using the UBDP and another using LBDP.
For the selected isolation system only the effective dynamic friction coefficient d is subject to
variability of its design value. The effective radius of the sliding surface Rb is a geometric property not
subject to any variability. The UBDP and the LBDP for d are calculated in accordance with EN 19982:2005+A1:2009, Annexes J and JJ.
Nominal value: d = 0.061 16% = 0.051 0.071
LBDP: d,min = minDPnom = 0.051
256
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
where:
2 = 0.5 is the combination factor for thermal actions for seismic design situation, in accordance
with EN 1990:2002 Annex A2,
o
Tmin = -20 C is the minimum shade air temperature at the bridge location having an annual
probability of negative exceedance of 0.02, in accordance with EN 1990-1-5:2004, 6.1.3.2.
1 = +5.0 C is the correction temperature for composite bridge deck in accordance with EN
1998-2:2005+A1:2009, Table J.1N.
o
f1 - ageing: max,f1 = 1.1 (Table JJ.1, for normal environment, unlubricated PTFE, protective seal)
f2 - temperature: max,f2 = 1.15 (Table JJ.2 for Tmin,b=-5.0 C, unlubricated PTFE)
o
f3 - contamination max,f3 = 1.1 (Table JJ.3 for unlubricated PTFE and sliding surface facing both
upwards and downwards)
f4 cumulative travel max,f4 = 1.0 (Table JJ.4 for unlubricated PTFE and cumulative travel 1.0 km)
Combination factor fi = 0.70 for Importance class II, i.e. average importance (Table J.2)
Combination value of max factors: U,fi = 1 + (max,fi - 1)fi (eq. J.5)
f1 - ageing: U,f1 = 1 + ( 1.1 - 1) x 0.7 = 1.07
f2 - temperature: U,f2 = 1 + (1.15 1) x 0.7 = 1.105
f3 - contamination U,f3 = 1 + (1.1 1) x 0.7 = 1.07
f4 cumulative travel U,f4 = 1 + (1.0 1) x 0.7 = 1.0
Effective UBDP:
UBDP = maxDPnom U,f1 U,f2 U,f3 U,f4 (equation J.4)
d,max = 0.071 x 1.07 x 1.105 x 1.07 x 1.0 = 0.071 x 1.265 = 0.09
Therefore the variability of the effective friction coefficient is: d = 0.051 0.09
257
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
the spectral acceleration Se(Teff, eff) corresponding to the effective period Teff and the effective
damping eff.
The effective stiffness at each support location consists of the composite stiffness of the isolator unit
and the corresponding substructure. In this particular example the stiffness of the piers is much
smaller than the stiffness of the isolators therefore the contribution of pier stiffness may be ignored
without significant loss of accuracy. The effective damping is derived using the following equation,
where ED,i is the sum of dissipated energies of all isolators i in a full cycle at the design displacement
dcd.
1 E D,i
eff =
2
2 K eff d cd
The design displacement dcd is calculated from effective period Teff and effective damping eff, both of
which depend on the value of the unknown design displacement dcd. Therefore the fundamental mode
method is in general an iterative procedure, where a value for the design displacement is assumed in
order to calculate Teff, eff and then a better approximation of dcd is calculated from the design
spectrum using Teff, eff. The new value of dcd is used as the initial value for the new iteration. The
procedure converges rapidly and a few iterations are adequate to achieve the desired accuracy. In
this example hand calculations are presented for the Fundamental Mode analysis for both LDBP and
UBDP. Only the first and the last iteration are presented.
8.4.5.2 Fundamental Mode analysis for Lower Bound Design Properties (LBDP)
The presented analysis corresponds to Lower Bound Design Properties (LBDP) of isolators i.e.
d=0.051. The iteration steps are presented analytically
Seismic weight: Wd= 36751kN (see loads)
Iteration 1
Assume value for design displacement dcd:
Assume dcd = 0.15 m
Effective Stiffness of Isolation System Keff: (ignore piers):
Keff = F / dcd = Wd x [ d + dcd / Rb ] / dcd =
36751kN x [0.051 + 0.15m / 1.83m] / 0.15m
Keff = 32578 kN/m
Effective period of Isolation System Teff: (EN1998-2 eq. 7.6)
Teff = 2
m
K eff
= 2
(36751kN / 9.81m / s 2 )
32578kN / m
= 2.13s
258
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
0.5
= 0.591
Teff = 2
m
(36751kN / 9.81m / s 2 )
= 2
= 2.27 s
K eff
28602kN / m
0.5
= 0.652
259
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
m
=2
K eff
Teff =2
0.5
= 0.511
260
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
m
(36751 kN / 9.81 m / s 2 )
= 2
= 1.84 s
K eff
43541 kN / m
Teff = 2
0.5
= 0.512
Typically LBDP analysis leads to maximum displacements of the isolating system and UBDP analysis
leads to maximum forces in the substructure and the deck. However the latter is not always true as it
is demonstrated by this example. In this particular example the LBDP analysis leads to larger shear
force (Vd=6292 kN) in the substructure than the corresponding shear force from UBDP analysis
(Vd=6096 kN). This is attributed to the fact that the increase of forces due to the effect of reduced
effective damping in the LBDP analysis (eff=0.1853 for LBDP vs eff=0.331 for UBDP) is more
dominant than the reduction of forces due to the effect of increased effective period in the LBDP
analysis (Teff=2.27s in LBDP vs Teff=1.84s in UBDP).
261
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
FNL is the force of the non-linear part of the structure (i.e. the isolators) which depends on the
The stiffness matrix K and the mass matrix M are determined from geometry, cross-section properties
and element connectivity of the structure. The damping matrix C is determined as a linear
combination of mass matrix and stiffness matrix according to the following equation (Rayleigh
damping):
C = aK + bM
For the examined structure the damping ratio of the system is =5% for all modes except for the
modes where seismic isolation dominates for which the damping of the rest of structure is ignored
=0. This behaviour is established by setting b=0. The coefficient a is determined as a =nn/ in
order to achieve damping n at period Tn. Assuming damping 5% at period 0.10s the coefficient is
a=0.00159 s. In Fig. 8.57 the damping ratio as a function of mode period is shown corresponding to
the applied damping matrix C. The damping for periods T > 1.5 s where seismic isolation dominates is
very small (<0.3%). For these periods energy dissipation occurs primarily from the non-linear
response of the isolators. For very small periods T < 0.05 s the damping increases significantly
(>10%). This is desirable because modes with periods in the same order of magnitude as the time
step cannot be integrated with accuracy and it is preferable to filter them with increased damping.
262
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
20.0%
17.5%
Damping
15.0%
12.5%
10.0%
7.5%
5.0%
2.5%
0.0%
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
Period (sec)
3.0
3.5
4.0
263
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
EQ2
-0.100
Force (KN)
-0.200
-0.300
Force (KN)
Direction Y
0.100
0.200
200
0
-0.100
0.000
-200
0.100
0.200
0
0.000
-200
0.100
Force (KN)
-0.200
-0.100
-0.100
0
-2000.000
0.100
-0.200
0
-0.100 0.000
-200
-0.200
-0.200
-0.100
Displ. (m)
-0.150
200
100
-0.100
0
-0.050 -1000.000
0.050
0.100
-0.200
-0.100
300
200
100
0
-1000.000
-200
-300
-400
-0.100
Displ. (m)
0.100
0.200
0.200
0.300
Displ. (m)
400
300
200
100
0
-0.100 -1000.000
-200
-300
-400
400
300
200
100
0
-1000.000
-200
-300
0.100
0.200
Displ. (m)
0.100
0.200
Displ. (m)
200
0
0.000
-200
0.100
-0.300
0.200
Displ. (m)
-400
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
EQ7
0.100
400
-0.200
-300
Displ. (m)
600
0.150
-200
0.300
200
-0.300
0.200
300
0.200
400
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
EQ6
0.100
600
-400
-600
0
0.000
-200
-400
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
-0.300
-0.200
Displ. (m)
200
Displ. (m)
-400
300
200
100
0
-1000.000 0.050 0.100 0.150 0.200
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050
-200
-300
Displ. (m)
-400
0.300
200
-0.300
400
0.200
400
0.200
600
0.100
600
-0.300
Force (KN)
EQ5
0
0.000
-200
-400
Force (KN)
200
-0.100
-0.100
Displ. (m)
-400
EQ4
0.300
400
-0.200
-0.200
Displ. (m)
400
Force (KN)
-0.300
200
-0.300
-400
EQ3
400
0.300
600
-0.200
600
Force (KN)
EQ1
Force (KN)
Direction X
400
300
200
100
0
-1000.000
-200
-300
-400
400
200
-0.200
-0.100
0
0.000
-200
0.100
0.200
0.300
-400
Displ. (m)
-600
Displ. (m)
Fig.8.58 Hysteresis loops for abutment bearing C0_L for the analysis with LBDP.
264
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Direction Y
Force (KN)
EQ1
Force (KN)
Direction X
400
200
0
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050 0.000
-200
0.050
0.100
Displ. (m)
EQ3
-0.100
Force (KN)
-0.200
Force (KN)
500
400
300
200
100
0
-1000.000
-200
-300
0.100
0.200
0.300
200
0
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050 0.000
-200
0.050
0.100
EQ5
-0.050
0.150
600
400
200
0
-0.150 -0.100 -0.050 0.000 0.050 0.100 0.150 0.200
-200
0.100
-0.150
0.150
400
200
0
-0.250 -0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050-2000.000
-0.100
0.050
0.100
-0.100
-0.050
-400
Displ. (m)
EQ7
-0.050
Force (KN)
-0.100
-0.150
Force (KN)
400
300
200
100
0
-1000.000
-200
-300
-400
0.050
0.100
Displ. (m)
300
200
100
-0.100
-0.050
0
-1000.000
0.050
0.100
-200
-300
-0.150
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
-600
EQ6
400
300
200
100
0
-0.050 -1000.000
-200
-300
-400
Displ. (m)
600
Displ. (m)
Displ. (m)
-400
Force (KN)
0.050
Displ. (m)
-400
Displ. (m)
Force (KN)
-0.100
400
300
200
100
0
-1000.000
-200
-300
Displ. (m)
200
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
EQ4
-0.100
400
300
200
100
0
-1000.000
-200
-300
400
300
200
100
0
-0.050-1000.000
-200
-300
-400
0.050
0.100
Displ. (m)
0.050
0.100
Displ. (m)
0.050
0.100
0.150
Displ. (m)
600
400
200
0
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050 0.000
-200
-400
0.050
0.100
0.150
Displ. (m)
Fig. 8.59 Hysteresis loops for abutment bearing C0_L for the analysis with UBDP.
265
0.150
0
-0.150 -0.100 -0.050 0.000 0.050 0.100 0.150 0.200 0.250
-200
-400
-600
0.100
400
Displ. (m)
400
0.050
600
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
-400
EQ2
0.150
400
300
200
100
0
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050-1000.000
-200
-300
-400
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Direction Y
Force (KN)
EQ1
Force (KN)
Direction X
1500
1000
500
-0.200
-0.100
0
-5000.000
0.100
0.200
0.300
-0.300
-0.200
-1000
Displ. (m)
EQ4
-0.200
Force (KN)
-0.300
Force (KN)
0.100
1500
1000
500
0
-0.100 -5000.000
-1000
-1500
-2000
0.200
0.300
-0.300
-0.200
Displ. (m)
2000
1500
1000
500
0
-0.100 -5000.000
-1000
-1500
Force (KN)
EQ3
-0.200
Force (KN)
-0.300
2000
1500
1000
500
0
-0.100 -5000.000
-1000
-1500
0.100
0.200
500
-0.200
-0.100
-0.050
-0.300
0
-0.100 -5000.000
-0.200
0.200
0
0.000
-500
1000
500
-0.100
0.050
0.100
0.150
Displ. (m)
-1000
1500
1000
500
0.100
-0.200
-0.100
0
-5000.000
0.100
0.200
-1000
Displ. (m)
500
0
-5000.000
0
-0.050 0.000
-500
Displ. (m)
0.050
Displ. (m)
1500
0.100
0.200
-1000
Displ. (m)
-1500
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
0.100
-1500
-0.150
1000
-1500
Displ. (m)
500
0.200
1500
-0.100
0.200
1000
Force (KN)
0.100
-1500
-0.200
0.100
1500
-1000
EQ7
0.300
Displ. (m)
-1500
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
2000
1500
1000
500
0
-0.100 -5000.000
-1000
-1500
-2000
500
-0.100
0.200
-1000
1000
-0.150
0.100
0
-5000.000
Displ. (m)
-1500
EQ6
Displ. (m)
500
-1000
-0.200
0.300
1000
Displ. (m)
1000
-0.300
0.200
-1000
0
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050 0.000 0.050 0.100 0.150 0.200
-500
EQ5
0.100
1500
Force (KN)
EQ2
Force (KN)
-1500
2000
1500
1000
500
0
-0.100 -5000.000
-1000
-1500
-0.300
1500
1000
500
-0.200
-0.100
0
-5000.000
0.100
0.200
-1000
Displ. (m)
-1500
Fig. 8.60 Hysteresis loops for pier bearing P1_L for the analysis with LBDP.
266
Displ. (m)
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
EQ4
Force (KN)
-0.150
-0.100
-0.050
Displ. (m)
0.100
0.200
0.300
0
0.000
-500
0.050
2000
1500
1000
0
-0.150 -0.100 -0.050-5000.000
0.100
0.050
1500
1000
500
Displ. (m)
0.100
Displ. (m)
-1000
0.150
1500
1000
500
-0.150
-0.100
-0.050
0.100
0.050
0
-5000.000
0.050
0.100
Displ. (m)
-1500
0.100
1500
1000
500
-0.150
-0.100
0
-0.050 -5000.000
0.050
0.100
-1000
Displ. (m)
1000
500
0
0.000
-500
0.050
0.100
-1000
-1500
Displ. (m)
-1500
Force (KN)
-1500
Force (KN)
-0.050
Force (KN)
0
-5000.000
-0.050
500
Displ. (m)
500
-0.100
1000
-1000
1000
-0.150
1500
-0.100
-1000
EQ7
0.050
Displ. (m)
-1500
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
Force (KN)
0.050
1500
-0.050
0
-5000.000
-1000
Displ. (m)
1500
1000
500
0
-0.250 -0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050-5000.000
-1000
-1500
-2000
-0.100
0.200
Displ. (m)
0
-0.150 -0.100 -0.050
-5000.000 0.050 0.100 0.150 0.200
500
0.050
0.150
2000
0.150
1000
0
-5000.000
0.100
-1000
Force (KN)
0.050
-1500
EQ6
0.150
Displ. (m)
-1000
EQ5
0.100
-1000
Displ. (m)
1500
-0.050
500
0.150
500
1500
1000
500
0
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050-5000.000
-1000
-1500
-2000
-0.100
1000
Force (KN)
2000
1500
1000
500
0
-0.100 -5000.000
-1000
-1500
Force (KN)
EQ3
0.100
Force (KN)
-0.200
0.050
1500
Force (KN)
EQ2
1500
1000
500
0
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050-5000.000
-1000
-1500
-2000
Force (KN)
EQ1
Direction Y
Force (KN)
Direction X
1500
1000
500
0
-0.200 -0.150 -0.100 -0.050-5000.000
0.050
0.100
0.150
-1000
Displ. (m)
-1500
Fig. 8.61 Hysteresis loops for pier bearing P1_L for the analysis with UBDP.
267
Displ. (m)
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
In Table 8.18 and Table 8.19 the time-history analysis results are presented for the left and right
bearing at each pier (P1_L, P1_R, P2_L, P2_R) and abutment location (C0_L, C0_R, C3_L, C3_R).
According to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 4.2.4.3 when the analysis is carried out for at least 7 seismic
motions, the average of the individual responses may be assumed as design value. The analysis
results correspond to the average of seven earthquake ground motions EQ1 to EQ7. The results
include the action effects of seismic action and permanent loads. They do not include the effects of
temperature and creep/shrinkage in the seismic design combination.
dEd,x is the displacement along longitudinal direction, dEd,y is the displacement in transverse direction,
dEd is the magnitude of the displacement vector in horizontal plane, aEd is the magnitude of the
rotation vector in horizontal plane, NEd is the vertical force on the bearing (positive when
compressive), VEd,x is the horizontal force of the bearing in longitudinal direction, VEd,y is the horizontal
force of the bearing in transverse direction, VEd is the magnitude of horizontal force vector.
Table 8.18 Bearings - Results of Analysis for Lower Bound Design Properties (LBDP)
Bearing
|dEd,x|
(m)
|dEd,y|
(m)
dEd
(m)
aEd
(rad)
NEd,min
(kN)
NEd,max
(kN)
|VEd,x|
(kN)
|VEd,y|
(kN)
VEd
(kN)
C0_L
0.193
0.207
0.255
0.00498
848.7
3310.3
346.0
375.7
469.0
C0_R
0.193
0.207
0.254
0.00509
860.4
3359.4
363.2
389.8
482.4
C3_L
0.199
0.207
0.258
0.00486
855.3
3323.9
402.5
372.0
501.4
C3_R
0.199
0.207
0.257
0.00494
858.5
3309.3
418.4
368.4
496.0
P1_L
0.188
0.193
0.244
0.00367
4541.1
12086.0
1328.5
1295.0
1654.2
P1_R
0.188
0.192
0.243
0.00381
4435.4
11994.8
1369.8
1284.5
1690.0
P2_L
0.189
0.193
0.245
0.00369
4560.3
12084.6
1336.1
1283.5
1654.3
P2_R
0.189
0.192
0.243
0.00380
4498.0
11912.9
1365.0
1283.2
1688.5
6929.3
6652.1
Total
Table 8.19 Bearings - Results of Analysis for Upper Bound Design Properties (UBDP)
Bearing
|dEd,x|
(m)
|dEd,y|
(m)
dEd
(m)
aEd
(rad)
NEd,min
(kN)
NEd,max
(kN)
|VEd,x|
(kN)
|VEd,y|
(kN)
VEd
(kN)
C0_L
0.149
0.139
0.182
0.00469
655.0
3157.9
352.6
380.4
449.8
C0_R
0.149
0.139
0.181
0.00475
624.1
3110.3
363.4
366.8
452.3
C3_L
0.157
0.139
0.185
0.00466
677.2
3112.5
400.6
368.6
489.6
C3_R
0.157
0.138
0.185
0.00461
684.8
3096.8
390.6
360.1
473.0
P1_L
0.149
0.128
0.173
0.00361
3912.7
11246.7
1361.8
1273.8
1630.8
P1_R
0.149
0.128
0.172
0.00355
3781.8
11408.5
1352.6
1185.7
1587.1
P2_L
0.150
0.128
0.173
0.00359
3793.6
11246.2
1379.7
1255.4
1605.7
P2_R
0.149
0.127
0.173
0.00354
3886.4
11378.4
1370.1
1187.1
1603.4
6971.3
6377.8
Total
8.4.6.3 Check of lower bound on action effects
268
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
with the Fundamental mode spectrum analysis. These lower bounds are applicable for both multimode spectrum analysis and time-history analysis. The verification of the displacement and shear
lower bounds is presented below:
o
From the above ratios it is concluded that the time-history analysis results compared to those of the
fundamental mode analysis are 12% smaller for displacements and 10% larger for total shear force.
This discrepancy between the comparison of displacements and forces is attributed to the effect of
vertical earthquake component on bearing forces, which is not taken into account in the Fundamental
Mode method of analysis. For spherical sliding bearings the horizontal bearing shear forces are
always proportional to the vertical bearing loads. The variation of the vertical bearing loads due to the
vertical ground motion component affects also the horizontal shear forces. This effect is evident in the
wavy nature of the force-displacement hysteresis loops of the isolators that were presented in the
previous paragraph.
-5
Piers:
-5
-5
-5
Where sign + corresponds to deck movement towards abutments and sign - corresponds to deck
movement towards bridge center.
The total offset displacement including the effects of permanent actions, long term deformations and
50% of the thermal action is calculated as follows:
Abutments:
Piers:
269
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
A particular aspect of FPS isolators is the fact that the displacement capacity of the bearing is the
same in all horizontal directions. The maximum displacement of the isolator occurs in a direction that
does not coincide in general with one of the two principal directions. The maximum required
displacement demand in the most critical direction may be estimated by examining the time history of
the magnitude of the resultant displacement vector in horizontal plane XY, including the effect of
offset displacements due to permanent actions, long term displacements, and 50% of the thermal
action. According to EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009, 7.6.2(1)P and 7.6.2(2)P the displacement demand is
required to be estimated in the principal directions and not in the most critical direction. However this
is not adequate for bearings with the same displacement capacity in all horizontal directions such as
the FPS bearings.
In Table 8.20 the displacement demand of the abutment and pier bearings is estimated in both
principal directions. Moreover the critical displacement demand in the horizontal XY plane is
estimated. It is concluded that for the examined case the displacement demand in the horizontal XY
plane is approximately 25% larger than the estimated displacement demand in the principal
directions.
Table 8.20 Required displacement demand of isolators
Bearing
Abutment bearings
C0_L, C0_R, C3_L,
C3_R
Pier bearings
P1_L, P1_R, P2_L,
P2_R
329
305
311
290
407
382
Maximum
407
382
Therefore the required displacement demand of the isolators is 407mm for abutment bearings and
382mm for pier bearings.
8.4.7.2 Restoring capability of the isolation system
The lateral restoring capability of the isolation system is verified in accordance with EN 19982:2005+A1:2009 7.7.1. The equivalent bilinear model of the isolation system is shown in Fig. 8.62,
where:
F0=dNEd
Kp=NEd/Rb
dp
is the maximum residual displacement for which the isolation system can be in static
equilibrium in the considered direction.
270
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Force
Kp
F0
Displ.
dcd
d0
d0
Longitudinal direction, LBDP: dcd / d0 = 0.193m / (0.051 x 1.83m) = 2.07 > 0.50
Transverse direction, LBDP: dcd / d0 = 0.207m / (0.051 x 1.83m) = 2.22 > 0.50
Longitudinal direction, UBDP: dcd / d0 = 0.149m / (0.09 x 1.83m) = 0.90 > 0.50
Transverse direction, UBDP: dcd / d0 = 0.138m / (0.09 x 1.83m) = 0.84 > 0.50
271
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
ductile/essentially elastic behaviour, i.e. q 1,50. The effect of q-factor is not included in the
presented results, and it will be included at the design stage of the pier cross-sections.
The following notation is used:
o
P is the vertical force i.e. axial force (positive when acting upwards),
M2 = MX is the moment about X axis (i.e. moment produced by earthquake acting in the
transverse direction), and M3 = MY is the moment about Y axis (i.e. moment produced by
earthquake acting in the longitudinal direction).
The signs of V2 / M3 are the same when their directions are compatible with earthquake forces
acting in the longitudinal direction. The signs of V3 / M2 are the same when their directions are
compatible with earthquake forces acting in the transverse direction.
Envelopes of maximum/minimum and concurrent internal forces are presented for each pier/abutment
location. For instance envelope max P corresponds to the design situation where the value of the
vertical force P is algebraically maximum. The values of other forces V2, V3, T, M2, M3 at max P
envelope are the concurrent forces when P becomes maximum.
The maximum/minimum and the concurrent forces for each envelope are derived as follows:
1.
The maxima/minima of each force (say maxM2, j=17) over all time steps of the history of
each motion j=17 are assessed. The design value of the maximum/minimum of the examined
force (say M2,d) is assumed equal to the average of these maxima/minima (maxM2, j=17) for
the 7 motions, i.e
M2,d = (maxM2, j=17) / 7
2.
The results of the seismic motion producing the extreme value (say maxmaxM2) of these
maxima/minima for all motions, and the corresponding time step, are used as basis for the
assessment of the concurrent values of the other forces. At the aforementioned results a
scaling factor is applied which is equal to the ratio of the design value of the examined force
(M2,d) divided by the extreme value (maxmaxM2), i.e. = M2,d / maxmaxM2.
272
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Table 8.21 Substructure - Envelopes of Analysis for Lower Bound Design Properties
Location
Envelope
Fz
(kN)
V2
(kN)
V3
(kN)
T
(kNm)
M2
(kNm)
M3
(kNm)
C0
max P
-1754.3
-18.3
158.3
-14.6
824.8
-1.8
C0
min P
-6535.1
-347.5
123.9
23.1
380.1
-34.7
C0
max V2
-4930.5
616.5
-163.2
85.1
-475.4
61.6
C0
min V2
-3688.2
-660.5
-115.7
-82.2
-482.2
-66.0
C0
max V3
-5623.1
617.2
684.1
-192.6
1933.0
61.7
C0
min V3
-4124.3
-469.5
-694.6
-190.5
-2002.9
-47.0
C0
max T
-2759.9
358.3
-393.2
183.1
-1388.7
35.8
C0
min T
-2989.8
-341.2
-505.2
-216.0
-1867.7
-34.1
C0
max M2
-3789.3
-383.9
608.9
272.1
2575.8
-38.4
C0
min M2
-4324.0
-493.4
-730.7
-312.4
-2701.2
-49.3
C0
max M3
-4930.5
616.5
-163.2
85.1
-475.4
61.6
C0
min M3
-3688.2
-660.5
-115.7
-82.2
-482.2
-66.0
C3
max P
-1787.9
-105.4
113.9
31.5
654.5
-10.5
C3
min P
-6439.8
379.4
134.5
-32.2
446.2
37.9
C3
max V2
-4241.8
783.1
-110.8
56.9
-328.9
78.3
C3
min V2
-3389.9
-562.1
-106.0
-66.8
-429.4
-56.2
C3
max V3
-5460.4
666.9
680.5
-238.2
2046.7
66.7
C3
min V3
-4149.3
-401.9
-660.4
-172.9
-1867.8
-40.2
C3
max T
-1975.2
257.9
-301.0
172.4
-1131.7
25.8
C3
min T
-2760.7
312.5
435.8
-215.7
1809.1
31.2
C3
max M2
-4001.7
453.0
631.7
-312.7
2622.4
45.3
C3
min M2
-4533.2
591.8
-690.8
395.7
-2597.2
59.2
C3
max M3
-4241.8
783.1
-110.8
56.9
-328.9
78.3
C3
min M3
-3389.9
-562.1
-106.0
-66.8
-429.4
-56.2
P1
max P
-12756.8
50.1
-236.8
60.2
-3971.0
254.0
P1
min P
-27232.5
228.2
640.6
451.2
7982.2
2143.8
P1
max V2
-16241.5
3339.4
-500.1
105.8
-4786.2
29347.6
P1
min V2
-17636.3
-2906.9
86.6
-77.7
-1838.1
-22629.6
P1
max V3
-16658.7
1112.7
2666.1
-758.9
33869.5
11127.1
P1
min V3
-15829.2
-909.9
-2698.2
-450.8
-27964.5
-9661.0
P1
max T
-8022.6
961.5
-813.0
575.0
-12731.0
9403.4
P1
min T
-13056.5
2514.3
919.9
-768.1
17367.8
22613.0
P1
max M2
-16393.7
1095.0
2623.7
-746.9
33330.7
10950.1
P1
min M2
-18669.2
-1073.1
-3182.3
-531.7
-32981.8
-11394.4
P1
max M3
-16142.4
3319.0
-497.1
105.2
-4756.9
29168.5
P1
min M3
-18598.0
-2499.2
-1830.2
-240.9
-15284.0
-26831.4
273
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Envelope
Fz
(kN)
V2
(kN)
V3
(kN)
T
(kNm)
M2
(kNm)
M3
(kNm)
P2
max P
-12560.1
-792.5
-174.2
161.5
4432.2
-6724.3
P2
min P
-27066.2
-230.7
715.6
-339.1
8957.0
-2180.8
P2
max V2
-16266.7
3383.2
-506.5
156.6
-4842.4
29890.9
P2
min V2
-17867.1
-2879.8
84.6
-83.3
-1807.9
-22406.6
P2
max V3
-16650.4
1099.1
2678.2
-777.1
34062.3
11054.4
P2
min V3
-15988.2
-956.8
-2711.5
-429.9
-28164.0
-10018.0
P2
max T
-7732.6
960.9
-781.8
575.5
-12189.7
9395.1
P2
min T
-12784.1
2478.8
860.4
-766.8
16575.8
22343.7
P2
max M2
-16276.3
1074.4
2618.0
-759.6
33297.0
10806.1
P2
min M2
-18798.5
-1125.0
-3188.1
-505.5
-33114.5
-11778.9
P2
max M3
-16195.0
3368.3
-504.3
155.9
-4821.0
29759.0
P2
min M3
-18734.3
-2470.9
-1809.2
-255.8
-15186.2
-26514.7
Table 8.22 Substructure - Envelopes of Analysis for Upper Bound Design Properties
Fz
(kN)
V2
(kN)
V3
(kN)
T
(kNm)
M2
(kNm)
M3
(kNm)
Location
Envelope
C0
max P
-1326.0
116.0
-80.6
-12.6
62.0
11.6
C0
min P
-6076.0
-594.2
-94.3
-38.4
-365.0
-59.4
C0
max V2
-3620.5
627.6
-93.9
53.1
-347.0
62.8
C0
min V2
-3503.1
-693.8
-158.1
-133.9
-687.2
-69.4
C0
max V3
-3737.8
149.9
686.9
-105.3
2696.7
15.0
C0
min V3
-3996.2
-375.4
-640.2
-176.4
-2085.3
-37.5
C0
max T
-2699.6
-22.2
-197.0
300.3
149.2
-2.2
C0
min T
-3260.5
479.0
471.3
-241.3
1937.6
47.9
C0
max M2
-3222.0
97.5
597.8
-89.8
2655.5
9.7
C0
min M2
-4111.4
-219.5
-555.6
-199.5
-2575.7
-21.9
C0
max M3
-3620.5
627.6
-93.9
53.1
-347.0
62.8
C0
min M3
-3503.1
-693.8
-158.1
-133.9
-687.2
-69.4
C3
max P
-1417.6
-76.4
45.9
61.4
384.7
-7.6
C3
min P
-6053.3
614.1
-86.6
37.5
-339.1
61.4
C3
max V2
-4215.2
768.4
-147.3
39.3
-381.3
76.8
C3
min V2
-3079.4
-586.3
-151.7
-96.5
-525.6
-58.6
C3
max V3
-4496.6
636.9
669.0
-347.4
2340.9
63.7
C3
min V3
-3930.0
-296.3
-635.4
-149.4
-2069.0
-29.6
C3
max T
-2417.7
325.0
-359.0
233.9
-1283.0
32.5
C3
min T
-2709.4
390.4
425.5
-285.9
1840.4
39.0
274
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Envelope
Fz
(kN)
V2
(kN)
V3
(kN)
T
(kNm)
M2
(kNm)
M3
(kNm)
C3
max M2
-3961.3
570.8
622.0
-418.1
2690.9
57.1
C3
min M2
-4233.5
-117.5
-558.0
-8.8
-2615.1
-11.8
C3
max M3
-4215.2
768.4
-147.3
39.3
-381.3
76.8
C3
min M3
-3079.4
-586.3
-151.7
-96.5
-525.6
-58.6
P1
max P
-11444.7
-125.6
566.0
7.6
7410.2
-1131.0
P1
min P
-25719.8
320.3
1735.7
382.5
22258.8
3219.5
P1
max V2
-15188.6
3632.5
-168.5
83.2
-2160.6
32565.5
P1
min V2
-17329.4
-3190.1
-282.4
-106.6
-3773.0
-27647.3
P1
max V3
-16196.9
1183.0
2666.2
-949.5
33694.2
12871.0
P1
min V3
-14597.6
1.4
-2828.3
-175.7
-29913.1
-580.6
P1
max T
-12907.1
1473.0
-804.9
693.2
-13503.0
14798.4
P1
min T
-11198.9
2406.9
983.3
-1016.0
18338.9
21664.8
P1
max M2
-15952.1
1165.1
2626.0
-935.1
33185.2
12676.5
P1
min M2
-15337.1
1.4
-2971.5
-184.6
-31428.6
-610.0
P1
max M3
-14829.4
3546.6
-164.5
81.2
-2109.5
31795.4
P1
min M3
-15090.4
-3183.3
127.2
-99.0
-246.6
-28584.3
P2
max P
-11479.8
216.1
583.7
-1.8
7643.4
2007.6
P2
min P
-25746.2
-28.7
1764.3
-409.5
22556.9
-372.2
P2
max V2
-15433.8
3702.6
-165.4
75.4
-2114.8
33190.2
P2
min V2
-15216.5
-3197.1
106.6
-115.6
-609.4
-28697.8
P2
max V3
-20549.5
280.4
2618.8
-304.4
29039.5
3324.9
P2
min V3
-14855.2
-49.9
-2856.8
-190.7
-30281.5
-930.3
P2
max T
-12267.8
1464.3
-764.4
741.6
-12727.1
14684.7
P2
min T
-11612.0
2520.1
953.8
-1006.9
17940.3
22796.5
P2
max M2
-16623.8
-340.0
2495.7
-120.7
32509.5
-2377.2
P2
min M2
-15508.7
-52.1
-2982.5
-199.1
-31613.6
-971.2
P2
max M3
-15110.2
3625.0
-161.9
73.8
-2070.5
32494.1
P2
min M3
-15128.2
-3178.6
106.0
-114.9
-605.9
-28531.2
General
The maximum normalized axial force of the piers is calculated in accordance with EN1998-2 5.3(4)
as:
k = NEd / (Ac x fck)= 27.2325MN / (5m x 2.5m x 35MPa) = 0.062 < 0.08
Therefore in accordance with EN1998-2 6.2.1.1(2)P no confinement reinforcement is necessary.
However due to the small axial force the pier should be designed by taking into account the minimum
reinforcement requirements for both beams and columns.
275
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
In accordance with EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009 7.6.3(2) for the substructure the design seismic forces
EE due to the design seismic action alone, may be derived from the analysis forces after division by
the q-factor corresponding to limited ductile/essentially elastic behaviour, i.e. FE = FE,A / q with q
1.50.
EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009 6.5.1 contains certain reduced ductility measures (confinement
reinforcement and buckling restraint reinforcement). However, it also offers the option to avoid these
measures if the piers are designed so that MRd / MEd < 1.30. This option is selected in this example for
reasons which will become transparent. Therefore for the design of longitudinal reinforcement the
design seismic forces FE are derived from the time-history analysis forces FEA as follows. FE = FE,A x
1.30 / 1.50.
The required reinforcement for the aforementioned design forces is calculated for flexural resistance
in accordance with EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009 5.6.2(1)P, for the most adverse design seismic actions,
2
NEd, M2,ed, M3,ed amounts to As = 213.7 cm , uniformly distributed over the section perimeter
No specific requirement for a minimum value of the longitudinal reinforcement is specified in EN 19982.
The minimum reinforcement for columns as specified in EN1992-1-1:2004, 9.5.2(2) is equal to:
As,min = max(0.1 x Nd / fyd, 0.002Ac) = max (0.1 x 27232.5kN / (500000kPa / 1.15), 0.002 x 5m
2
2
x 2.5m) = 0.025m = 250 cm
i.e. min = 0,2%
EN1992-1-1:2004, 9.2.1.1(1) specifies (for beams) a minimum tensile reinforcement for avoiding
brittle failure following exceeding of the tensile concrete strength. This minimum is also applicable for
any member for which flexural ductility is required. For uni-axial bending the minimum reinforcement
of the tensioned face amounts
1,min = max (0.26 x fctm / fyk, 0.0013)
For the total minimum reinforcement min of a rectangular section this leads to:
min 3 1,min = 3 max (0.26 fctm / fyk , 0.0013) max (0.8 fctm / fyk , 0.004)
For concrete C35/45 with fctm = 3,2 MPa and for reinforcement class C fyk = 500 MPa
min = 0.00512 = 0,51 %
For the examined pier cross-section
As,min = 0.00512 x 500cm x 250cm = 640 cm
In summary:
2
Shear
276
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
a) The design action effects shall be calculated in accordance with EN1998-2 5.5(1)P, where the
seismic action effect AEd shall be multiplied by the behaviour factor q used in the linear
analysis.
b) The resistance values, VRd,c, VRd,s and VRd,max derived in accordance with EN 1992-1-1:2004,
6.2 shall be divided by an additional safety factor Bd1 against brittle failure, with
recommended value Bd1 = 1.25. Therefore for the design of shear reinforcement the design
seismic forces FE are derived from the time-history analysis forces FEA as follows. FE = FE,A x
1.25.
The required reinforcement for the aforementioned design forces is calculated for flexural resistance
in accordance with EN 1998-2:2005+A1:2009 5.6.2(2)P. The results are presented below:
max. spacing = 0.6 x min (20 x 28mm, 2500mm, 400mm) = 240mm, Provided longitudinal
spacing = 150mm < 240mm ok
min. diameter = (6mm, 28mm / 4) = 7mm, Provided bar diameter = 12mm > 7mm ok
The provided shear reinforcement also satisfies the minimum requirements of EN1992-1-1:2004,
9.2.2 for beams:
o
max. longitudinal spacing sl,max= 0.75 x d x (1+cot) = 0.75 x 2400mmm * (1+0) = 1800mm,
Provided longitudinal spacing = 150mm < sl,max= 1800mm ok
min. shear reinforcement ratio w,min = 0.08 x (fck) /fyk = 0.08 x (35) / 500 = 0.095%,
Provided shear reinforcement ratio: w=0.174% in longitudinal direction and w= 0.107% in
transverse direction > w,min = 0.095% ok
0,5
277
0,5
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
0,53
0,53
0,53
5,0m
0,53 0,53
0,53
0,53
0,53
0,53
2,5m
Envelope
Fx
(kN)
Fy
(kN)
Fz
(kN)
Mx
(kNm)
My
(kNm)
Mz
(kNm)
Max Fx envelope
783
111
4242
329
78
57
Max Fy envelope
470
695
4124
2003
47
191
Max My envelope
3625
162
15110
2070
32494
74
Max Mx envelope
1095
2624
16394
33331
10950
747
278
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
Vertical
direction Z
Transverse
direction Y
Mz
My
Longitudinal
direction X
Fz
Mx
Fx
Fy
Fig. 8.64 Direction of forces Fx, Fy, Fz and moments Mx, My, Mz with positive sign for
foundation design.
It is evident that the displacement of the FPS isolator in one direction only, as is considered
by the FMM, is by necessity coupled to a simultaneous displacement in the transverse
direction. This is of course valid also for the max displacement dcd that is estimated by the
FMM. For estimating an appropriate value for the transverse displacement occurring
simultaneously with the max value dcd, one should take account of the following two facts.
The behavior of this isolator type is the same in all directions and the two seismic motion
components, are considered to be statistically independent, but having similar frequency
content. It is evident that the targeted value depends heavily on the characteristics of the two
horizontal components of the seismic motion. However, a reasonable assumption for the
probable value of the simultaneous transverse displacement appears to be of the max
displacement i.e. 0.5dcd. Consequently, the effective value dcd,e of the max displacement, i.e.
the length of the vector sum of the simultaneous displacements, may be assumed equal to
dcd,e 1.15dcd
The increased value dcd,e should be used also for the estimation of the max forces transferred
through the isolator in any direction, as the isolator has no preferred directions.
The vertical seismic motion component on the other hand, has also an effect on the variation
of the friction forces of the isolator. The effect oscillates, with equal positive and negative
values, about a zero mean value. This effect can be observed in the hysteresis loops of
Fig.8.58, Fig. 8.59, Fig. 8.60, Fig. 8.61, for some of the seismic motions used (e.g. EQ7, and
EQ3). The oscillations occur at much shorter periods than those of the horizontal motion,
corresponding to the much higher frequency content of the vertical seismic component (see
Fig. 8.51 and Fig. 8.52). Consequently this influence may be ignored at least regarding the
279
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
max displacements. Regarding the forces, the application also on the friction forces of the
1.15 multiplier estimated above, is a convenient approximation.
In Table 8.24 the displacement demand of abutment bearings and the total abutment shear are
presented. In this table the following results are compared: a) the results of the time-history
analysis as presented in the previous paragraphs and b) the results of the Fundamental Mode
Method (FMM) using the 1.15 multiplier estimated above. The estimated displacement demand
using the FMM is 3% larger than the corresponding displacement demand from time-history
analysis. The estimated total shear using the FMM is 13% less in longitudinal direction and 3%
less in transverse direction than the corresponding shear from time-history analysis.
Table 8.24 Comparison of displacement demand and total shear for abutment bearings in
longitudinal direction
Displacement
demand
(mm)
Total shear in
longitudinal
direction
(kN)
Total shear in
transverse
direction
(kN)
Time-history analysis
407
783
695
Fundamental Mode
Method (FMM)
419
683
683
Method of analysis
280
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
References
Boore, D. M. and J. J. Bommer. 2005. Processing of Strong-Motion Accelerograms: Options and
Consequences. Soil Dynamics and Earthquake Engineering 25: 93115.
Choi, D. H., and S. H. Lee. 2003. Multi-Damping Earthquake Design Spectra-Compatible Motion
Histories. Nuclear Engineering and Design 226: 22130.
281
Chapter 8: Overview of seismic issues for bridge design (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2) B. Kolias
282
APPENDICES
284
APPENDIX A
Wolfang HENSEN
PSP - Consulting Engineers
Markus FELDMANN
RWTH Aachen University
Gerhard SEDLACEK
RWTH Aachen University
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
A-2
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
1.
Introduction
(1)
Sustainability is a key-issue for the design of bridges including steel bridges. The most
important sustainability indicator for bridges is durability with its effect on life cycle costs for an
intended service life of about 100 years.
(2)
(3)
Therefore this report does not focus only on design rules in Eurcode 3, but also comprises the
other elements of the European Standard Family affecting durability, amongst which
Eurocode 3 plays an important role.
(4)
According to the general concept of the Eurocodes these codes consist of a European part
(the EN-codes) and National Annexes to the EN-codes, that complement the harmonized
European EN-codes by National choices.
(5)
In conclusion the practical design of a bridge on a certain territory is not possible without the
use of the National Annex valid for that territory.
(6)
The choices that are contained in the Eurocodes comprise the following:
1.
2.
3.
National responses to opening notes to Eurocode rules that include technical classes
or factors related to safety, climatic, cultural and other aspects (see Guidance Paper L
Use and application of Eurocodes).
Response to informative annexes with technical rules and sets of alternative
technical rules in the main code-text for which no agreement could be achieved during
the code-writing phase and from which CEN/TC250 expects either National
acceptance or better founded National Alternatives that could be used by CEN/TC250
for further harmonisation of the rules and the reduction of complexity and volume.
Non conflicting complementary informations, (NCCIs) that comprise National
choices of additional technical rules necessary for filling gaps in the Eurocodes and to
make them fully operable. From these NCCIs CEN/TC250 expects important
impulses for the further development of the Eurocodes.
(7)
Therefore in this report reference is made to the Nationally Determined Parameters, which
are recommended in the Eurocodes for the design of Steel bridges and in some cases to the
draft German National Annex, that may be considered as an example for the variations that
may be induced by the many National Annexes in the EU.
2.
(1)
Figure 1 gives the structure of the report with a short introduction to the European Standard
Family, the aspect of durable load assumption in particular from traffic on road bridges, an
A-3
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
example how to overcome shortcomings in the Eurocode-rules for the technical specifications
for the delivery of bearings, the background and use of EN 1993-1-10 for the choice of steel to
avoid brittle fracture and the core of the design of steel elements in bridges, that
encompasses the stability rules, the fatigue rules and rules for tension elements, e.g. for
stayed cable bridge.
LIST OF CONTENTS
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
Figure 1
A-4
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
3.
General remarks to the European Standard Family for the design of steel bridges
(1)
Steel bridges for roads comprise full steel bridges with steel decks (orthotropic plates) and
steel-concrete-composite bridges with a concrete deck, see Figure 2 and Figure 3.
Figure 2
HASELTALBRCKE SUHL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
Figure 3
A-5
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(2)
In both examples the main structure is a stiffened box-girder with cantilevering plates with the
assembly of sections prefabricated in the workshop on one shore on site and erection by
launching.
(3)
There is a criticism that the design of bridges would become more and more complicated
because of the large amount and large volumes of the standards making the users life
difficult.
As the detailing of rules that produces the volumes is however required by the users there are
two possibilities to create a better survey:
1.
2.
to develop appropriate navigation systems through the standards (as practiced e.g.
for the EN-standards for energy-efficiency),
to develop consolidated handbooks from the standards for particular application
fields as e.g. bridges, in which the technical rules and references from the Eurocodes
are assembled in a way suitable for water-tight contracting and security of use.
Examples for such handbooks in bridge design are
No. 1: Basis and design of actions for bridges
No. 2: Design of concrete bridges
No. 3: Design of steel bridges
No. 4: Design of composite bridges
as practiced in Austria and Germany.
Load combination
EN 1990
Safety aspects
EN 1990-A2
G/Q-values
EN 1993-1-1
Imperfections
EN 1993-1-5
EN 1993-1-5
Stability of plates
EN 1993-1-9
Fatigue
EN 1998-3
Self-weight
actions
design
EN 10025
Materials
Welding
EN 1337-6
CE-marking
Traceability
Thermal actions
EN 1991-1-5
Connections
Ropes
Prefabrication
EN 1991-1-4
Bearings
execution
Site work
Tolerances
product
conformity
EN 1991-2
Wind actions
General
Seismic design
EN 1090-2
Traffic actions
EN 1991-1-1
Inspection
Maintenance
EN 1993-2
EN 1993-1-8
EN 1993-1-11
EN 1337
EN 1090-2
EN 1337
EN 1090-2
EN 1090-2
EN 1337-10
Figure 4
(4)
Figure 4 shows a shortened example for a navigation system related to actions, design,
execution and product conformity that allows the user to google the rule he needs.
A-6
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
EN 1990
Eurocode: Basis of Design
EN 1992 to EN 1996
EN 1991
Eurocode 1: Actions on Structures
Eurocode 2: Concrete structures
1-1 Self weight
Eurocode 3: Steel structures
1-2 Fire Actions
Eurocode 4: Composite structures
1-3 Snow
Eurocode 5: Timber structure
1-4 Wind
Eurocode 6: Masonry structures
1-5 Thermal Actions
1-6 Construction Loads
1-7 Accidential Actions
2
Traffic on bridges
3
Loads from cranes
EN 1997 and EN 1998
4
Silo loads
Eurocode 7: Geotechnical Design
Eurocode 8: Design in seismic areas
EN 1999
Eurocode 9: Aluminium structures
Figure 5
(5)
Figure 5 gives a survey on all Eurocodes from which the user should select those rules
relevant to his design works:
Under the general principles in EN 1990 - Basis of Design - there are on one side the various
generic rules for actions (as snow and wind) and the specific action rules as e.g. traffic loads
on bridges and on the other side the material-dependant rules for various materials and types
of structures. EN 1997 - Geotechnical Design - and EN 1998 - Design in seismic areas comprise both generic rules for actions and specific rules for resistances and materials.
A-7
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
hEN
product standards
for steel materials,
semi- finished
products etc.
HSS up to
S700
1.12
Figure 6:
(6)
Figure 6 shows the organisation of the family of standards for the design of steel bridges.
The umbrella standard for Delivery Conditions for prefabricated steel components on the
global market with a part for the conformity assessment is EN 1090-Part 1.
This part takes reference to
-
(7)
hEN product standards that give product properties from testing methods defined by
statistical characteristics that are suitable for a reliable design,
the Eurocodes that give design rules both for prefabricated components and for
structural works,
EN 1090-2 that contains the rules for execution in the workshop and on site with rules
for good workmanship, tolerances etc.
Eurocode 3 comprises in a similar way as the action-code generic design rules in its central
part 1 addressing e.g. plate buckling and fatigue, and specific additional rules in peripheric
application parts as for bridges (Eurocode 3 - Part 2), that take reference to the generic rules
in Part 1.
A-8
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
Load combination
Safety aspects
Self-weight
actions
G/Q-values
Traffic actions
Wind actions
Thermal actions
designer
Imperfections
General
Stability of plates
design
Fatigue
Connections
Ropes
Bearings
Seismic design
Materials
Prefabrication
Welding
execution
Corrosion protection
Site work
Tolerances
CE-marking
Traceability
product
conformity
contractor
Inspection
Maintenance
In this report only rules for actions and for design are addressed as demonstrated in Figure 7,
whereas rules for execution and product conformity that are mainly used by the contractors
are not dealt with.
A-9
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(9)
Figure 8 gives the design rules in Eurocode 3 which are relevant for the design of steel
bridges.
The controlling part for design is Eurocode 3 - Part 2, with reference to Eurocode 3 - Part 1-1,
in particular to general rules for structural analysis, cross-sectional verifications, use of
imperfections for stability checks e.g. flexural buckling, and lateral torsional buckling, to Part
1-5 for plate buckling, to Part 1-8 covering connections, to Part 1-9 for fatigue, to Part 1-10 for
choice of material and to Part 1-11 for rope structures.
(10)
EN 1993-2 has an Annex C with recommendations for the design and the execution of
orthotropic steel bridge decks covering now 50 years of experience with durable deck plates,
that may make specific numerical fatigue checks unnecessary.
(11)
EN 1993-2 contains also the annexes A and B for the preparation of specifications for the
delivery of bearings and transition joints, for which EN 1990 Annex A 2 did not give specific
rules. These annexes are material independent so that they are applicable to concrete-, steeland composite-bridges. Therefore in the future they will be transferred to EN 1990, and the
tentative titles Annex E1 and E2 have been agreed.
(12)
These new Annexes should in particular contain appropriate rules for the representative
values of actions and their combinations to give design values of forces and movements that
are in compliance with the evaluations of measurements as obtained from many decades of
use; the values now recommended in the Eurocodes would produce movements that are in
the range of 1.5 2.0 of the values experienced in the past and also would not be suitable for
the specification of bearing characteristics from an integral analysis of the total system of
superstructure, bearings, piers and foundations.
(13)
Therefore the draft of German National Annex related to Requirements for bearings and
transition joints is related to the future Annexes E1 and E2 and contains a proposal that
prevents the problems as described above.
A - 10
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
10
The basic assessments that a bridge designer has to accomplish are listed in Figure 9:
-
4.
4.1
(1)
The loading model LM1 as specified in EN 1991-Part 2 gives a European uniform geometric
pattern of concentrated loads and uniformly distributed loads the magnitudes of which have
been decided to leave them to the choice of each Member State to obtain a sustainable
loading model, see Figure 10.
A - 11
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
11
900 kN
500 kN
275 kN
11,0 m
Load-model LM1
Figure 10
(2)
The loading pattern as well as the recommended values for the loads originate from a
common European study made under the chairmanship of H. Mathieu in the 1st phase and
Prof. J.A. Calgaro in the final phase, that was carried out by specialists of various EUmembers on the basis of measurements in the various countries undertaken in the late
1980ths.
(3)
The composition of the road traffic in the Highway Paris-Lyon at Auxerre has been decided to
be the statistical basis for defining recommendations for characteristic values, as this
composition seemed to be representative for future developments in all Europe.
(4)
The characteristic values were defined with a return period of 1000 years instead of the usual
values of 50 years because of the prevailing requirement of serviceability on this level and
sustainability of decision.
Whereas a 50 years-return period would have meant a 98%-fractile of the annual distribution
of extreme values in the mean (i.e. for 50% of the bridge population), the 1000 years-return
period means a 98%-fractile of the annual distribution of extreme values for 95% of the bridge
population.
(5)
The responses of Member States in their NAs are expected not to be homogeneous,
because
traffic conditions are very regional,
some countries use extraordinary loads in addition to the standard load model,
some countries use load classes for their road-network.
A - 12
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
12
1000 kN
12
600 kN
6
300 kN
3
11,0 m
An example for a response is the draft loading model in the German NA as given in Figure 11.
It reflects the following conditions:
1.
All -values are equal or above 1.0 because the future trends in traffic developments
must be taken into account. In comparing the characteristic vehicle weights for a
length of 11m the increase is about 10%.
2.
The values of the uniformly distributed loads are increased by 1.30 except for the
second heavy lane where the increase is by 2.40.
This is due to the results of evaluations of traffic measurements performed during the
drafting works and explained hereafter.
The increase of about 1.30 is justified by simulations of future traffic compositions
(including 60 t modular heavy vehicles) taking account of rubber trains with a freight
volume substantially larger than used today and with a smarter freight management.
3.
(7)
This example is specific for Germany being the largest transit country at the crossing point of
North-South- and East-West-traffic and with limited controls on the roads.
4.2.
Background of the load model LM1 and of the recommended characteristic load values
(1)
The statistical background of traffic measurements on the highway in Auxerre has been
documented as given in Figure 12.
(2)
It has been used with other statistical data to perform dynamic numerical simulations with
bridges of various influence surfaces to obtain a realistic view on the statistics of action
effects in the bridges. To this end the dynamic behaviour of vehicles has been modelled by
rigid bodies with non linear springs, dampers and friction elements and the surface roughness
A - 13
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
of the asphalt was artificially generated with Power Spectral Density classifications according
to ISO-TC 108, see Figure 13.
13
14
A - 14
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
15
Modelling of bridges
Figure 14
(3)
(4)
The results of the simulations are given in Figure 15 for the case of mid-span moments of a
three span continuous bridge. Apparently the effects of load model LM1 are safesided in this
case to cope for other requirements from other influence lines.
A - 15
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
16
17
Dynamic effects
Figure 16
(5)
A - 16
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
4.3
(1)
Reliability analysis of load model LM1 was performed with two medium spanned steel bridges
with orthotropic decks that were built in Germany with the National Loading Code DIN 1072,
see Figure 17.
18
K 210
K 138
19
A - 17
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(2)
A reliability analysis on the basis of the statistics of the traffic in Auxerre and the statistics of
large-scale tests used to define characteristic values of resistancies in Eurocode 3 gives the
-value found is
target value for a probabilistic design of bridges with various influence lines to identify a partial
factor
20
P r o b a b ilis t ic d e s ig n
Qd
re q u ire d
f W
y
E C 1 - P art 2 L o ad M o d el
req u
w h e re
LM
Q
Qd
LM
Q
= 1 .1 0
= 1.3 5
M
M
Qd
LM
Q
Definition of Q-value
Figure 19
(4)
The probabilistic design gives for various shapes of influence lines and spans the
resistances Wrequired of the main girders that comply with
= 6.00.
fy
yield strength
MG
1.35
1.10
a design value
-
In using on the other hand load model LM1 the moment caused by traffic loads
From a comparison of
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
21
Figure 21
A - 19
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(5)
Figure 20 gives the distributions of Q -values obtained in this way for various influence lines,
spans and road widths. It shows the large scatter of values and also that Q =1.35 is the
maximum.
(6)
Figure 21 demonstrates what happens if in the load model LM1 the uniformly distributed load
in lane 1 is slightly reduced and in lane 2 enhanced by a factor of 2:
The scatter of Q is smaller and the maximum values are in the range of 1.25, so that
could be reduced to
M =1.00.
-values in the draft German NA.
(7)
4.4
(1)
Figure 22 gives a forecast of the year 2000 for the future development of freight volume of
terrestic traffic that has been exceeded in 2010 by far.
(2)
Figure 23 gives the development of requests for permanent travelling permissions for heavy
vehicles exceeding the legal weight limits, resulting in about 100 requests per day.
23
Forecast of freight-volume
Figure 22
A - 20
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
24
Figure 24 gives the vehicle and axle loads and accumulated number of vehicles as measured
by weigh-in-motion (WIM) methods in an access highway to Rotterdam in the Netherlands for
1 year.
25
Results of WIM-measurements in NL
Figure 24
(4)
A - 21
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
1.
the recommendations for LM1 are not overcautious,
2.
there are tendancies to increase the traffic loads by developing larger vehicles to
reduce CO2-emissions,
3.
a clear picture of a future load-model can only be obtained where clear decisions
from transport-politics are made. Such decisions should not ignore the large impact of
such decisions on the sustainability of the loading model for the existing infrastructure.
4.5
4.5.1
(1)
A numerical means to assess durability is the fatigue assessment, that requires the definition
of the two-dimensional fatigue actions in terms of a pair of values:
-
(2)
26
Traffic Category
2 106 / a
0,5 106 / a
0,125 106 / a
0,05 106 / a
This damage equivalent vehicle represents a certain frequency distribution of various heavy
vehicles in the traffic spectrum, evaluated with the slope m=5 of the fatigue resistance lines.
A - 22
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
For application in numerical fatigue assessments, which are not based on fatigue damage
(two dimensional), but on stress-ranges only (one dimensional), the model is used in the
following way:
-
dynamic effects and the specific characteristics of the spectrum considered in the
project.
(4)
Figure 26 gives the concept for this fatigue assessment, that usually works with partial factors
Ff and Mf , depending on the safety concept applied. Usually the concept of Damage
tolerance is used, which requires, that any fatigue damage, i.e. the formation and growth of
cracks, can be detected in regular inspections of the structure, before the damage attains a
size critical for the ultimate resistance of the structure.
Ff
fa t
27
m ax
Mf
s a fe ty fa c to r
f o r f a t ig u e s tr e n g th
r e fe r e n c e f a t ig u e s t re n g th
a t 2 1 0 6 c y c le s
m a x im u m s tr e s s r a n g e f r o m
E C 1 -2 lo a d m o d e l
d a m a g e e q u iv a le n c e fa c t o r
r e p r e s e n t in g t h e s p e c t ru m
crack size a
critical
crack
size acrit
d a m a g e e q u iv a le n t
im p a c t f a c t o r
detectable
crack
size a0
s a f e ty fa c t o r
f o r fa tig u e lo a d
Ff = 1.00
Mf = 1.00 1.15 for damage tolerance
Mf = 1.25 1.35 for safe life method
time
Inspection interval
Figure 26
(5)
The fatigue resistances c are based on constant amplitude tests with large scale
specimens, that contain all features of welded structures (discontinuities and residual
stresses). Figure 27 gives an example for detail categories c as specified in EN 1993-1-9
and evaluations of test results that support the choice of c made in EN 1993-1-9.
The comparison shows that for some details there may be a large scatter of tests, from which
the choices have been made and that for other details the basis of tests is rather small.
A - 23
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
There may be also the problem, that for details chosen in a project either the fatigue loading
or the fatigue resistance may only be roughly estimated, so that ways of fatigue assessment
other than by the numerical way are preferred, e.g. prescriptive rules for fatigue or substitutive
rules for serviceability.
28
(1)
An example for the derivation of a descriptive rule for achieving sufficient fatigue resistance is
given in Figure 28. In comparing the moment resistances of main girders resulting from ULSverifications with Load-model LM1 and from fatigue assessments with Load-model FLM3 all
for a certain minimum fatigue resistance, e.g.
A - 24
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
29
Required moment of inertia from ULS and fatigue design for detail
category 71
c = 71 MPa,
-
(3)
Figure 29 gives another example for descriptive rules for certain details. In this case the
connection of hangers of tied arch bridges, for which various details are common could be
standardised in such a way, that fatigue from:
vortex induced vibrations
rain-wind-induced vibrations
fatigue from imposed deformations from the passing of fatigue vehicle on the
bridge
are taken into account.
A - 25
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
30
31
Figure 30 gives such an example for a standardized solution that may be defined by
geometric descriptions only. The background of these geometric descriptions are fatigue
assessments for the critical hot spots , , , that have been undertaken for a large
variety of bridges to prove their safety.
A - 26
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(5)
A particular case for descriptive rules is the orthotropic steel deck of bridges, see Figure 31.
The most critical hot spot for such plates is the welded connection of the deck-plate to the
troughs or to the webs of the cross-beams.
32
Figure 31
33
HV
HV
300
300
12
14
300
design life
load model 4
without layer
< 10 years
asphaltic
30 - 50 years
sealing
PmB 45
thermosetting
70 - 90 years
resin
PmB 25
fr t = 6 mm
A - 27
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(6)
The fatigue loading model FLM3 is not applicable for verifying these hot spots, because it
does not sufficiently model the effects of the tyre-pressure of the wheels. Also the analysis
model for fatigue is not sufficient, if it is restricted to modelling the steel structure only.
(7)
Figure 32 demonstrates in what way the steel-deck adhesively connected with the asphalt
layer is affected by the stiffness of the layer and its sensitivity to temperature and loading
frequency.
Taking Polymer modified Bitumen PmB45 into account produces an enhancement of service
life by a factor of 3 to 5 and PmB25 generates an enhancement by a factor of 7 to 9.
(8)
Therefore Annex C to EN 1993-2 gives prescriptive rules for the most critical details of
orthotropic plates, e.g. deck-plate thickness, distance of troughs, weld preparations for
welded joints of stiffeners etc. to secure a sufficient fatigue life.
34
hQTr
25
t Steg
tLtrough = 6 mm
tweb = 10 - 16 mm; verification of net web section required
hcrossbeam 700 mm
Figure 33
(9)
An example for the structural details dealt with in Annex C is the interconnection of troughs
and webs of cross-beams according to Figure 33 and the definition of a minimum depth of
cross-beams and minimum thickness of web-plate to avoid the formation of cracks at the cutout for which a tooth-assessment in the critical horizontal section between the cut-outs is
necessary.
A - 28
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
4.5.3
(1)
A particular protection aim for orthotropic steel decks is to avoid cracks in the asphalt-layer
that could lead to corrosion of the deck-plate and in case of disintegration of the layer to
security problems of the road users.
(2)
35
From an evaluation of the ratio of the frequency of occurrence of cracks in the asphalt versus
the maximum strain exerted from differential deflections of the ribs a minimum requirement of
the stiffness of troughs has been derived that is given in Figure 35.
A - 29
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
36
5
A
4
3
0
1000
5000
10000
15000
20000
4
Figure 35
(4)
This minimum stiffness requirement, specified in EN 1993-2, also protects the deck-plate from
excessive fatigue stresses.
(5)
Another indirect fatigue assessment given in EN 1993-2 is the verification to excessive webbreathing, that may lead to cracking at the welded edges of the web-plate and also avoids the
hungry horse-appearance.
(6)
Figure 36 shows the relevant plate-buckling-formula applied for stresses on the service
level.
A - 30
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
37
Plate buckling
Verification to
web breathing
x ,Ed ,ser
k E
Ed ,ser
+ 1.1
k E
1.15
Definition of a plated
element
Figure 36
38
Figure 37
4.5.4
(1)
The JRC has prepared a background document to EN 1991-Part 2 Traffic loads for road
bridges and consequences for the design -, see Figure 37, that is currently being extended to
include also the background of the traffic loads for railway bridges.
A - 31
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(2)
That background document gives the origine of the load specifications and could be used as
a source for determining tendencies from more recent traffic measurements or from studies
that include further developments of heavy vehicles.
5.
5.1
(1)
Two examples for models used for the design of steel bridges are presented in this report,
that are connected with durability checks:
-
Model for shear lag for wide flanges e.g. the bridge-deck cooperating with the main
girders as top flange,
Model for fatigue design.
5.2
(1)
The basis for the model of shear lag in EN 1993-1-5, to which EN 1993-2 makes reference, is
the beam theory extended to cover shear deformations.
(2)
full cross-section with the full geometric flange width b . It gives the warping
distribution z ,
-
w
in the wide flange
s
w dA = w dA + k A = 0
w z dA = w z dA + k A
0
1w
zw
zz
=0
apply,
it gives a vertical deformation
A - 32
M w that may be
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
Mw
w
Aww
w =
-
the sum of
z =
Mz
z
Azz
and
w =
Mw
w
Aww
beff = b
39
GS
Figure 38
A - 33
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
40
Figure 39
(3)
Figure 39 shows a moment distribution for a continuous beam where this model could be
applied:
-
is calculated from
For the ease for use however the moment distribution of the continuous beam is divided into
various unit distributions, each of which can be modelled by a simply supported beam with a
combination of uniformly distributed load and concentrated load, where is the relevant
shape parameter for the moment shape.
A - 34
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
41
Figure 40
(5)
0 b , where
=1
>1
for orthotropic flange plates, where the longitudinal stiffness is larger than the
shear stiffness
<1
for cracked concrete slabs, where the longitudinal stiffness for tension is
smaller than the shear stiffness
(6)
-value
has
been chosen.
5.3
Modelling for ultimate limit state verifications and for fatigue assessments
(1)
Whereas the modelling of the structures for ultimate limit state verifications may be simplified,
e.g. by hinged connections at the junction of deck-plate and vertical stiffeners of cross-frame,
fatigue assessments need a modelling of the monocoque structure taking into account the
continuity of deformations of the deck-plate and of the transverse frame to take the
restraining moments into account, see Figure 41.
A - 35
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
42
Differences in modelling
Modelling for ULS
Figure 41
(2)
Also small curvatures of a bridge in plan view normally neglected in the analysis for ULS may
induce lateral forces in the hogging and sagging moment regions of the main-girders that may
enhance the restraining moments in the transverse frame.
(3)
Fatigue damages have also been observed at the connections of longitudinal stiffeners in
webs of main-girders, that normally are designed for plate buckling under perfect-loading
conditions for ULS, however in case of flexible deck-plates may receive lateral imposed
deformations from deflections of the cross-beams under traffic loads, see Figure 42.
A - 36
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
43
Differences in modelling
Modelling for ULS
Figure 42
44
Differences in modelling
Modelling for ULS
Figure 43
(4)
A typical difference in modelling for ULS and fatigue is given in Figure 43 for box-girderbridges, where transverse frames are usually designed for load distributing forces calculated
on the basis of rigid cross-section shapes, whereas for fatigue the distortion of the crosssection and secondary moments induced by the continuity of deformations of the deck-plate
and the transverse frame may be relevant.
A - 37
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
6.
6.1
General
(1)
EN 1990 Annex A2 does not give rules for the determination of action effects as forces,
moments and movements for specifying the performance conditions for the delivery of
bearings.
(2)
Therefore the preparation of such rules is a first priority task for Non-conflicting
complementary information to EN 1990 A2 to make the Eurocodes fully operable for the
design of bridges.
(3)
EN 1993 Part 2 gives in its Annex A Requirements for bearings that are meant to be
independent on different materials and ways of construction.
(4)
This Annex needs however further development to achieve the following goals:
-
the rules should give realistic results in that they comply with measurements of forces
and movements from many decades,
the rules should be applicable for all types of fixed, sliding, rolling and deforming
bearings,
the rules should allow to derive the specifications for bearings from a global analysis
of the bridge for ULS comprising the interaction of superstructure, bearings, piers,
foundation and the soil. This specification should be consistent with the design of the
support area of the superstructure (e.g. for eccentricities), the design of the piers (e.g.
loading and excentricities) and of the foundations.
(5)
The rules should also be consistent with the properties of bearings, as specified in the product
standard for bearings, i.e. EN 1337.
(6)
In the following the main contents of such a future Annex E to EN 1990, that would substitute
the now Annex A to EN 1993-2 is presented.
6.2
Figure 44 gives the design principles for the preparation of construction documents
(1)
needed to order the delivery of bearings according to EN 1337.
A - 38
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
45
Figure 44
46
Construction documents
Bearing plan (drawing of the bearing system)
Bearing installation drawing (structural details)
Bearing schedule (characteristic values from each
action, design values from combination of action)
Figure 45
(2)
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
6.3
(1)
After the choice of the bearing plan with selection of the types of bearing, see Figure 46,
bearing schedules need to be prepared, for which Figure 47 and Figure 48 give models.
sliding
47
rolling
deforming
displacement
rotation
Figure 46
(2)
In Figure 47 the characteristic values of action-effects (forces, moments and movements) are
given for each individual action, so that load combinations can be performed that allow to
define either extreme values together with simultaneous accompanying actions or
conservative combinations of extreme values only.
A - 40
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
48
Figure 47
49
Figure 48
(3)
Figure 48 gives an example for the indication of design values from the combination of
extreme characteristic values.
(4)
The bearing schedules are then used by the bearing producers to design the bearings
according to the rules in EN 1337.
A - 41
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(5)
The reference standards for the preparation of the bearing schedules are given in Figure 49
and Figure 50. For accidental design situations also EN 1991-2 should be taken into account
with particular rules for the impact scenarios for bridges to be considered. The National Annex
may give descriptive rules (e.g. limitation of bridge movements by structural measures) that
apply instead of numerical assessments.
50
Action
Eurocode
Reference to temperature T0
DIN EN 1991-1-5:2004-07
1.1
1.2
1.3
Self-weight
Dead loads
Prestressing
1.4
1.5
Creep concrete
Shrinkage of concrete
DIN EN 1991-1-7:2007-02
DIN EN 1991-1-7:2007-02
DIN EN 1992-1:2005-10 and
DIN EN 1994-2:2006-07
DIN EN 1992-1:2005-10
DIN EN 1992-1:2005-10
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
2.9
2.10
2.11
2.12
2.13
2.14
2.15
2.16
Traffic loads
Special vehicles
Centrifugal forces
Nosing forces
Brake and acceleration forces
Footpath loading
Wind on structure without traffic
Wind on structure with traffic
Range uniform temperature
Vertical temperature difference
Horizontal temperature difference
Soil Settlements
Bearing resistance/friction forces
Replacement of bearing
Pressure and suction from traffic
Wind during erection
2.17
2.18
Construction loads
Accidental actions
DIN EN 1991-2:2004-05
DIN EN 1991-2:2004-05
DIN EN 1991-2:2004-05
DIN EN 1991-2:2004-05
DIN EN 1991-2:2004-05
DIN EN 1991-2:2004-05
DIN EN 1991-4:2005-07
DIN EN 1991-4:2005-07
DIN EN 1991-1-5:2004-07, 6.1.3 and 6.1.5
DIN EN 1991-1-5:2004-07, 6.1.4 and 6.1.5
DIN EN 1991-1-5:2004-07, 6.1.4 and 6.2
DIN EN 1997-1:2009-09
DIN EN 1337, Part 2 to 8
DIN EN 1991-2:2004-05
DIN EN 1991-2:2004-05
DIN EN 1991-4:2005-07 and
DIN EN 1991-1-6:2005-09
DIN EN 1991-1-6:2005-09
DIN EN 1991-1-7:2007-02
For transient design situations reduction of variable actions due to limited duration EN 1991-2, 4.5.3. For steel
bridges also actions from installation of hot asphalt according to technical project specifications.
Figure 49
51
Figure 50
A - 42
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
6.4
(1)
Figure 51 gives the principles for the determination of design values of movements and
bearing forces when using the combination rules.
52
Figure 51
(2)
In order to comply with the requirement of realistic behaviour the following particularities
should be taken into account:
-
the F -value for climatic temperature effects cannot exceed the value F = 1.35 , so
that this value should be chosen instead of the recommended value F = 1.5 .
Creep and shrinkage should be taken into account by using mean values multiplied
with a factor of 1.35.
Non uniform distribution of permanent loads should be considered by applying
(3)
For determining the design values of movements from the design values of extreme
temperatures TEd ,min and TEd ,max the safety system in Figure 52 should be used. It comprises
two elements
-
A - 43
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
typical hour of measurement (e.g. early morning for steel-structures, afternoon for
composite structures).
-
53
T0 [C]
Installation of bearing
steel bridges
composite bridges
concrete bridges
10
10
10
25
20
20
Td = Ted,max - Ted,min
For non-linear behaviour stepwise determination
Td = F TN
Figure 52
54
Reaction forces at fixed points resulting form resistance of the bearing system
For sliding bearings:
r [ G ,inf Gk ]
other variable actions
vertical actions of traffic load
Forces from
acceleration and
braking
Figure 53
(4)
For continuous bridges over deep valleys with tall piers the fixed bearings may be installed on
one or two of the tall piers in the middle of the bridge.
A - 44
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(5)
In this case the horizontal forces from braking and friction in the bearings to be applied to
these fixed bearings may be taken from Figure 53.
(6)
This Figure also gives the horizontal forces for the case that bearing may not be caused by
friction but by elastic restraints (elastomeric bearings).
7.
7.1
General
(1)
All design rules for steel-structures are based on the evaluation of large scale tests that have
been performed at room temperature.
(2)
At this temperature (~20C) steel normally exhibits a ductile plastic behaviour, so that large
plastic strains occur at the ultimate limit state, that cause stress-redistributions in the crosssection and make the use of nominal stresses without geometric and metallurgic notch
effects and without consideration of secondary moments possible and hence make the design
rules simple.
(3)
Not so in the low temperature region where ferritic steels may show in dependancy of their
toughness properties a fracture mechanism under tension loads that macroscopically may be
classified as brittle, because plastic deformations are small and failure occurs without
significant plastic deformations.
(4)
The choice of material to avoid brittle fracture therefore mainly aims at choosing the
toughness properties of steel such, that only ULS-verifications in the ductile domain are
necessary and other failure mechanisms in the low temperature region can be ignored.
(5)
To meet this goal the toughness of steel that is required, needs to be determined by a fracture
mechanics assessment of the component, taking account of
-
(6)
This fracture mechanics assessment is not a fitness for purpose check, as the assumptions
e.g. the presence of cracks are only hypothetical. It has the character of a check for an
accidental design situation and hence produces robustness for the unprobable case that
one or more of the hypothetical assumptions would hold true.
A - 45
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(7)
Whereas the requirement of robustness is often described in qualitative terms, e.g. by the
requirement to avoid progressive collaps, the robustness from the choice of material to avoid
brittle fracture is expressed quantitatively.
7.2
(1)
A particularity of the choice of material for steel-bridges is that the design value of crack a d
assumed at the hot spot of a structural component is very much affected by fatigue, see
Figure 54.
(2)
Hence the initial crack size a0 overlooked in testing after fabrication is assumed to be
enhanced by crack growth due to fatigue actions. The fatigue action taken into account is one
quarter of the full fatigue damage
D = c3 2 10 3
Choice of material
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
55
Assumption for a0
c 3 2 10 6
ad = a0 f
a0
ad
fatigue loading
initial crack
design crack
Figure 54
(3)
The fracture mechanics assessment is performed with stress intensity factors K , one for the
action side
K appl ,d
which is influenced by the member shape, the crack size and the frequent stresses
Ed = 1 E ,ULS
according to the combination rules for accidental design situations, and on the resistance side
A - 46
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
K mat ,d
which includes the temperature T27J from Charpy-V-notch impact tests that produce an impact
energy of 27 Joule.
This assumption makes it possible to establish a link between the fracture mechanics
assessment and the necessary number of inspections during the service life of the structure.
(5)
It also produces structures that are damage tolerant, because the crack growth from
hypothetical cracks is sufficiently slow, to provide long inspection intervals, and the
inspections create a prewarning system, so that in case unforeseen damages are detected,
there is sufficient time to intervene before damages attain a critical size.
7.3
(1)
The safety approach that links the fracture mechanics assessment for ductile material
behaviour in the various temperature domains may be taken from Figure 55.
(2)
This Figure shows the toughness-temperature curve with the upper shelf domain B1 and the
transition temperature domain A1 with low toughness values. It also shows the loaddeformation characteristic from large scale tests to determine design resistances in the ductile
domain B3 and in the elastic domain A2 .
(3)
The third graph in Figure 55 gives the lines of equal probability of action effects from
combinations of actions for bridges:
-
For persistent and transient design situations the load level B2 applies for normal
A - 47
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
56
Toughness-temperature - Load-strain-diagram
Design situations in the upper-shelf region B and the transition region A of the
toughness-temperature diagram
Figure 55
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
57
Transformation
Assessment scheme
TEd TRd
Action side
TEd = Tmin + Tr + T + TR + [T + Tpl ]
TEd TRd
Resistance
TRd = T100
Influence of material toughness
T100 = T27J 18 [C]
b
appl 20 eff 10
25
k R6
T = 52 ln
[ C ]
70
Figure 56
(4)
Figure 56 shows the basic formula for the determination of the minimum toughness properties
in EN 1993-1-10 which results from the transformation of the equation with stress itensity
factors K to temperatures T .
This temperature oriented equation allows to take additional strain rate effects and coldforming effects into account by simple temperature-shifts T .
A - 48
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(5)
The basic formula with temperatures has been used to calculate the maximum thickness
values of steel products depending on the grade and subgrade of steel., the reference
temperature TEd and the nominal frequent stress Ed , see Figure 57.
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
58
Figure 57
(6)
At present this table with maximum thickness values is extended to make it applicable to coldformed hollow sections structures, stainless steel and also for the choice of material for plastic
design (upper shelf behaviour).
7.4
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Features of the crack growth up to a plastic angle are then used to classify the test result
as passed or failed.
A - 49
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
59
Figure 58
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
60
Figure 59
(5)
Figure 59 gives the results of such tests from quality tests of steel producers related to the
Charpy-V-notch impact energy and the thickness of the product from which the samples were
taken.
A - 50
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(6)
The conclusion from Figure 59 is the recommendation in Figure 60, according to which the
choice of fine grain steels is necessary for product thicknesses greater than 30 mm.
(7)
This choice supersedes the choice according to the table in Figure 57.
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
61
Figure 60
7.5
(1)
A conventional steel bridge, with composite box-girder section is given in Figure 61.
The plate thickness of the upper flange and the bottom plate of the box girder that attain
values up to 135 mm have been chosen to EN 1993-1-10.
A - 51
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
62
Example: Thick plates for the composite Elbebridge Vockerode (EN 1993-1-10)
Cross section
Support
75
Span
140 145
30 70 70 95 45
50
Support
Upper chord
145
75
75
Bottom plates
40
70
70
50
70 95 45 30
40
40
70
40
125,28
Construction at supports
Figure 61
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
63
Figure 62
(2)
A non-conventional composite bridge consisting of two separate bridge parts with a triangle
cross-section (and an open joint between the decks in the middle) is the St. Kilian bridge in
Figure 62.
(3)
The bottom chord of this truss bridge with circular hollow sections is a single tube with nodes
made of cast steel.
A - 52
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(4)
The robustness of this structural concept is assured by the choice of material according to EN
1993-1-10 that produces damage tolerance together with the usual inspection regime for
bridges.
In conclusion the cross-section with a single bottom chord made of steel with sufficient
toughness is robustness-equivalent with other cross-sections with more than 1 bottom chord
or bottom chords made of steel lamellas (because of redundancies) that have low toughness
values (as experienced for existing riveted bridges).
(5)
A particular feature of this robustness concept is the appropriate choice of the fatigue class,
which is mainly influenced by the execution quality.
(6)
Figure 63 gives an impression of the erection work, Figure 64 shows the weld preparation
between the cast steel nodes and the tubes (with small tolerances) and Figure 65 gives an
impression of the cast nodes.
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
64
Figure 63
A - 53
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
65
Figure 64
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
66
Figure 65
7.6
Further information
(1)
More details of the background of the choice of material for bridges may be taken from the
JRC report Commentary and Worked examples to EN 1993-1-10 Material toughness and
through thickness properties and other toughness oriented rules in EN 1993, see Figure 66.
A - 54
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
5. CHOICE OF MATERIAL
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
67
Figure 66
8.
8.1
Stability rules
General
(1)
(2)
For these buckling phenomena in general two assessment approaches are applicable:
1.
2.
(3)
nd
2 order assessment with initial equivalent imperfections, that cover the various
structural and geometric imperfections a structural member may have,
use of buckling formulas for uniform structural member with defined loading and
boundary conditions which should have been derived from 1.
For practical use buckling formulas for standard cases are very important. Figure 67 gives the
common verification concept applicable to the various buckling phenomena, where the
definitions are:
ult ,k =
A - 55
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
crit =
global slenderness
6. DESIGN OF BRIDGE-ELEMENTS
6.1 STABILITY RULES
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
68
Common design rules for column, lateral torsional, plate and shell buckling
Ed
Ed
Ed
Ed
Ed
sk
lk
column buckling
ult ,k Ed = Rk
crit Ed = Rcrit
EN 1993-1-1
1,00
a0
a
b
0,80
a
b
0,40
0,20
0,20
EN 1993-1-6
1,0
0,8
0,8
a0
0,60
()
1,2
0,40
Ed
EN 1993-1-5
1,0
1,00
shell buckling
ult ,k
crit
1,2
EN 1993-1-1
1,20
0,80
0,60
plate buckling
Rk
=
Rcrit
Ed
Ed/2
p [-]
1,20
0,6
0,6
0,4
0,4
0,2
0,2
0,00
0,00
0
0,5
1,5
2,5
0,5
Ed
1,5
2,5
0,0
0,0
Rk
M
0,5
1,0
_
p [-] 1,5
2,0
2,5
3,0
0,0
0,0
0,5
1,0
1,5
2,0
2,5
3,0
ult ,k
M
Figure 67
(4)
For steel bridges the conditions for the application of standard formulas are rare, so that a 2
nd
order assessment or a simplified 2 order assessments are preferred.
(5)
nd
are the relevant phenomena, and shell buckling does in general not occur.
nd
(6)
Therefore this report gives the background of the imperfections to be used in 2 order
nd
analysis and a simplified 2 order analysis which includes the application of such
imperfections in the so-called General method that allows to use reduction coefficients for
buckling also in cases where loading and boundary conditions are not standardized.
8.2
(1)
The uniform column with hinged ends loaded in compression is the reference component for
the definition of equivalent geometric imperfections and simplified procedures with reduction
A - 56
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
formula as it is also used for resistance tests to column buckling to which the methods are
calibrated.
(2)
Figure 68 gives the principles for the derivation of the European flexural buckling curve:
1.
It is assumed that the buckling resistance of the column can be expressed in terms of
the cross-sectional resistance to compression and to bending that results from
equivalent geometric imperfections and second order effects.
The critical cross section is in the middle of the column.
2.
The shape of the equivalent geometric imperfection is taken equal to the elastic
critical buckling mode, that corresponds to the elastic critical eigenvalue (Euler-critical
load), to establish a link to boundary and loading conditions other than those of the
reference component.
3.
4.
the slenderness
M Rk
N Rk
The imperfection factor is the open parameter determined from test evaluation; this
parameter is associated with a linear resistance model
N Ed M Ed
+
=1
N Rk M Rk
in which N Rk and M Rk are the characteristic values of resistances, that may be
either elastic or plastic.
5.
Rk = N pl ,k
2.
Rd =
Rk
A - 57
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
69
Column buckling
Figure 68
(3)
As a result of the derivation in Figure 68, Figure 69 gives the shapes of the reduction factors
for various cross sectional shapes, to which various -values belong, see Figure 70.
A - 58
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
70
71
The ratios of experimental results re and results calculated with the formula for the reduction
coefficient are given in Figure 71 for weak axis buckling. Figure 72 shows the partial
factors M that result from test-evaluation according to EN 1990 Annex D, to obtain the
design values ( R = 0.8 3.8 = 3.03 ) .
A - 59
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
73
74
A - 60
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
8.3
(1)
E d Rk
see Figure 73. The usual 2nd order approach with imperfections is based on the balance
E d Rd .
(2)
In conclusion the results for the two different balances can be only made consistent, if for the
nd
normal 2 order approach with imperfections one of the following options is applied:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
for normal 2
nd
order theory the partial factor *M is larger than M for the buckling
curve.
E d = Rk
N pl
N crit
= ( , )
Rk = , N pl
Rd =
75
Rk
E d = Rd
d =
N pl , d
N crit
d = ( , d )
Rd =
d N pl
M
Consequences:
Option 1:
Ed = M .Ed
Option 2:
N crit ,d =
Option 3:
M = 1.0
N crit
M
ed = e0
1 2
1
Option 4:
Option 5:
M* =
d
M
A - 61
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
76
0.5
0.685
0.870
0.477
0.661
0.895
1.03
1.0
1.136
0.597
0.953
1.082
0.627
1.05
1.5
1.846
0.342
1.43
1.734
0.369
1.08
2.0
2.806
0.209
1.906
2.605
0.228
1.09
3.0
5.476
0.10
2.859
5.039
0.109
1.09
g=
Figure 74
(3)
*M = g M .
(4)
2.
in case of M > 1.00 , e.g. M = 1.10 , the difference between the functions M and
*M to the constant value M is so small that both for the use of buckling curves
and for 2
nd
nd
8.4
(1)
The use of the elastic critical buckling mode crit allows to extend the applicability of the
cross-sectional check in Figure 68 and hence the reduction factor to any other boundary
conditions as given in Figure 75, e.g. by modifying the buckling length.
A - 62
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
77
NEd
NEd
EI
NEd
a1
NEd
ini = e0 d sin
Me = e0 dNEd
x
l
ini = e0 d
1
x
sin
NEd
l
1
Ncrit
Me = e0 d
2
crit
crit
crit,max
NEd
crit
NEd crit,max
1
2
EI crit
78
Figure 76
(2)
the initial equivalent geometric imperfection is not referred to max. crit , but to max.
//
//
, and the shape of crit
is the shape of bending moment from imperfections.
crit
A - 63
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
crit also the bending moment M e according to 2nd order theory can be easily
determined.
The extension of the application of the flexural buckling curve is not limited to onedimensional structures as columns, bars etc., but also to two dimensional structures
as grids, see Figure 76, for which the condition applies that external forces do not
change their value in dependance of buckling deformations (conservative loading).
8.5
(1)
A beam with equal end-moments, which effects compression in one flange can be assessed
in a similar way as a column, if the assessment is performed for the flange in compression for
out-of-plane buckling, see Figure 77.
79
Column buckling
NEd
M
+ Ed = 1
Npl,Rk My ,Rk
Fl
NFlEd My ,Ed
+ Fl = 1
Fl
Npl,Rk My ,Rk
NEd NEde *
+
Npl,Rk My,Rk
Mz ,Ed
1
=1
N
1 Ed
Ncrit
Mz ,Rk
Mz ,Ed NFlcrit *
e
Mz ,crit MFly ,Rk
1
=1
Mz ,Ed
1
Mz ,crit
M yFl,Rk
e* = M 0.2 Fl
N pl ,Rk
M y ,Rk
e* = N 0.2
N pl ,Rk
N + N
*
=7
8
6
=}
1
=1
N 0.2
1 2N
N
M + M
1
M
=1
0.2
2 M
1 2M
Fl
M
+ 2
2
= 0 ,5 1 + 0.2 +
The hypothesis used in the derivation in Figure 77 is that the equivalent geometric
imperfection e* for the flange is the same as for a column with flexural out-of-plane buckling.
(3)
The derivation shows that for lateral torsional buckling the same expression as for flexural
buckling is obtained, however with the difference, that the imperfection factor is reduced to
* by the effect of the St. Venant-torsional rigidity, which is determined by the ratio
2
M
2
Fl
*
crit
crit
A - 64
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
where
2
M
2
Fl
is the slenderness for the lateral torsional buckling problem based on crit
is the slenderness of the isolated flange in compression; that can also be expressed
*
by crit
calculated without St. Venant-torsional rigidity.
(4)
Figure 78 gives the difference between the flexural buckling curve b and the lateral torsional
buckling curve with reduced imperfection factor * for a HEB 200 beam.
(5)
Test evaluations with all available test reports for lateral torsional buckling tests have proven
that the lateral torsional buckling curve as given in Figure 77 gives the best fit with M -values
in the range of 1.05.
80
Comparison of LTB-curves
LT
Lateral torsional buckling
for GIT=oo
1,0
Lateral torsional
buckling for a beam
HEB 200
Bc a
Bc b
0,0
0,0
1,0
2,0
LT
Figure 78
(6)
A generalisation of the procedure in Figure 77 leads to the rule for determining the reduction
factor for any out-of-plane stability problem, that may be composed of mixed flexural and
lateral torsional buckling and includes any out-of-plane boundary condition, see Figure 79.
A - 65
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
81
Procedure for lateral torsional buckling assessments using the buckling curves:
1. Input parameters:
ult ,k =
Rk
Ed
crit =
Rcrit
Ed
ult ,k
critt
where
*
crit
crit
*
crit
is determined without effect of G I D
= 0 ,5 1 + * ( 0.2 ) + 2
=
2 2
ult ,k
1
M
Figure 79
(7)
If the design point x d is known, where the sum of in-plane stresses and out-of-plane stresses
from imperfections give the relevant maximum value, the input parameters can be calculated.
In this case ult ,k is determined at the point x d .
If the design point x d is not known, ult ,k can be conservatively estimated as ult ,k ,min .
(8)
*
If the two elastic critical values crit with torsional rigidity and crit
without torsional rigidity
* =
(9)
Figure 80 shows an example for a beam with unequal end-moments, where the design point
is at a distance xd = 0.155 l from the maximum loaded end.
A - 66
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
82
If for convenience the assessment is carried out with ult ,k at the maximum loaded end x = 0 ,
the results are either conservative or a modified buckling curve mod is used, that includes a
correction with on the basis of knowledge where the design point xd is.
8.6
(1)
The location of the design point x d for lateral torsional buckling where in-plane- and out-ofplane effects sum up to a maximum can be determined with the knowledge of the distribution
of in-plane effects and out-of-plane effects.
(2)
Figure 81 shows for a two span beam, the loaded top flange of which is to be checked, the
distribution of in-plane moments and in-plane stresses in the flange and the modal out-of-
, that are
plane displacements crit and modal out-of-plane flange moments E I (x ) crit
produced together with the elastic critical eigenvalue crit .
(3)
There are two possibilities for the lateral torsional buckling check:
-
//
crit
nd
A - 67
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
83
check:
=
ult ,k
crit
= *,
ult ,k
1
M
(1)
For a welded portal frame of an industrial hall with the dimensions and support conditions for
out-of-plane movements as given in Figure 82 the distribution of in-plane-action effects
according to Figure 83 apply.
A - 68
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
84
Lateral support
3
24012
5505
24015
1068
5565
24015
knee-point
5
8000
24012
S 355 J2 G3
6
7
0
24420
Figure 82
85
ult.k.min=1.55
Moment distribution [kNm]
ult.k (xd)=1.94
Figure 83
A - 69
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
86
xd
Figure 84
(2)
The distribution of bending moments in Figure 83 gives the location for ult ,k ,min = 1.55 and
the maximum curvature in Figure 84 gives the design point x d , for which ult ,k (xd ) = 1.94
applies.
87
ult ,k = 1.55
ult ,k = 1.94
crit = 1.85
*
crit
= 1.84
1.55
= 0.915
1.85
*
1.54
* = crit =
0.49 = 0.408
crit
1.85
1.94
= 1.05
1.85
LT = 1.225
+ 2 2
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(4)
1.
2.
A by-effect of the calculation is that takes values 0.5 , so that in the bolted end-plate
connection at the knee points of the frame out-of-plane bending moments can be resisted by
full contact and no additional loads to bolts have to be considered.
(5)
Figure 86 and Figure 87 give the example of a composite bridge with an open cross section,
for which the out-of-plane stability of the bottom chord in compression in the hogging moment
region of the continuous beam is of concern.
88
Figure 86
A - 71
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
89
Figure 87
(6)
The moment distribution for girder no. 1 for which the out-of-plane stability check has to be
carried out is given in Figure 88.
90
Figure 88
A - 72
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(7)
For the lateral torsional buckling check the bottom chord can be either regarded as a
continuous column, laterally supported by the elastic transverse frames at the support, see
Figure 89, and all 7.50 m, see Figure 90.
91
Figure 89
92
Figure 90
(8)
A - 73
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(9)
The other possibility is to model the cross section fully or partly with FEM, to consider the
effects of torsion and distorsion of the steel cross section.
(10)
In Figure 91 modal transverse displacements of the bottom flange of the critical girder are
given for the first 3 eigenvalues. The area where the modal transverse moments attain their
maximum values are marked.
93
critical area
critical area
critical area
Figure 91
94
critical areas
Figure 92
A - 74
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(11)
Figure 92 gives the inplane stresses in the centre line of the bottom flange as well as the yield
stresses from which ult ,k -values can be determined, that are possible choices for the design
point x d .
(12)
at the design point x d for the first modal displacement (in field)
2.
at the design point xd for the third modal displacement (at the support).
In these calculations also the modification of the imperfection factor by torsion has been
taken into account.
95
330
= 1.83
180
295
= 1.184
250
crit = 8.8576
crit = 17.489
1.83
= 0.45
=
8.8576
*
crit
= 8.37
* =
8.37
0.76 = 0.72
8.86
1.184
= 0.26
17.489
*
crit
= 15.20
= 0.69
15.20
0.76 = 0.66
17.49
= 0.554
= 0.82
= 0.96
* =
Figure 93
9.
9.1
(1)
It is a common feature of column buckling and lateral torsional buckling, that in-plane stresses
that initiate out-of plane buckling are not affected by out-of plane deformations; i.e. the normal
compression force in a column does not vary with imperfections or buckling displacements
and the in-plane stress situations in a beam-column does not vary if lateral deformations in
terms of lateral displacements and torsion take place.
(2)
The only differences between flexural buckling and lateral torsional buckling is the effect of
torsional rigidity that is expressed by the modification of the imperfection factor in the
formula for the reduction factor .
A - 75
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(3)
column-like behaviour without any overcritical resistance however with the effect of
torsional rigidity occurs if the edge loads are imposed and do not vary with the
displacements under these loads. In consequence the displacements of the loaded
edges are non-linear.
plate-like behaviour with overcritical resistance and also with the effect of torsional
rigidity occurs if under the effect of imperfections the edge loads are applied as a
group of loads, that cause a linear displacement of the loaded edge. In this case the
individual loads of the group may vary with the displacement and cause a non-linear
distribution with a load shedding from the centre to the edges.
96
resulting displacements i
at loaded edge
Plate-like behaviour:
resulting loads
on loaded edge
imposed displacement
on loaded edge
Figure 94
(4)
In general plate-buckling verifications are made for plated elements of girders, beams and
columns under action effects as bending moments, normal forces and shear forces. For these
structures the axiom of Navier applies, i.e. linear distributions of strains and not of stresses
may be assumed.
(5)
At points of local load introductions as patch loads on the flanges of girders, beams and
columns however the loads are normally controlled by mechanisms that limit their variation
with displacements (e.g. by introduction by rollers on springs). In this case the behaviour is
more column-like or in between column-like and plate-like behaviour.
9.2
(1)
Figure 95 gives the example of a column with a cross-section in the form of a cross, for which
according to EN 1993-1-1 a torsional buckling check may be performed.
A - 76
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
97
CM =
b3 t 3
9
IM = 4
= A sin
Column:
x
e
;G =
E
2(1 + )
Plate:
ECM + G I M
l
iM2
N crit
cr =
A
E t2 2
6
2 b
(
)
(
)
1
1
2
12(1 2 ) b 2 14243
4
l 1
24
3
142
4 43
4
b3
t
3
x
y
w = A sin
b
l
i a = 0
N cr =
cr =
b
+ 0,429
0,9
l 44244444
1444
3
k
N crit
A
E t 2 2 b
6
(
)
1
2
12 1 2 b 2 {
4
l 1
24
3
142
4 43
4
b
e + 0,429
=
42443
1l4
k
Figure 95
(2)
Using the column approach for torsional buckling a critical stress cr may be determined with
the cross-sectional data C M and I M , from which a buckling coefficient k may be derived.
(3)
Using the plate theory a buckling coefficient k may also be determined using the energymethod with a modal buckling deformation that corresponds to the assumptions mode for
torsion in the column check.
(4)
(5)
The differences result from the type of loading as given in Figure 96.
A - 77
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
Torsional buckling
98
column-like behaviour
plate-like behaviour
compression
stress
N =
N
A
response
strain
compression
strain
N =
N
A E
response
stress
bending
geometric strain effect:
M = (1 ) f y
N
N
2
2
2
2
N crit
eo s N crit
2
l 4 b
N
1
N crit
geom (s ) =
Figure 96
(6)
In torsional buckling a geometric strain effect occurs due to the torsional deformations, that
-
(7)
These different distributions of stress N from compression, either constant or parabolic, are
superimposed with linear distribution of stresses M in the plated elements from plate
bending.
A - 78
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
99
column buckling
plate buckling
1 f y
1 f y
bending
k fy
fy
fy
=1
+ * 0
sd = b
0 = 0.2
assumption:
=1
)1 1 = 1
)1 1
* + * * 0.7
* =
0 = 0.7
1
=
+ 2
sd < b
assumption:
+ * 0.7
+ * 0.2
1+
~
2
compression
compression
+ * 0
k=
bending
= 0.5 1 + * 0.2 +
=1
+ 2
) ]
= 0.5 1 + * 0.7 +
Figure 97
(8)
Figure 97 shows the effects of the assumptions of a constant or parabolic distributions of the
compression stress:
-
The conclusion of a constant stress distribution is the column buckling formula with
the modified imperfection value *
the conclusion of the constant strain distribution is the modified imperfection value *
and that
the basic equation of the column buckling formula does not attain the value
1.0 (for the yield stress) but only a mean value between and 1.0, best
represented by
the design point in the cross-section s d moves from the edges to the centre
of the cross-section which causes a -effect as for lateral torsional
buckling.
(9)
, so that
for constant stress distributions the lateral torsional buckling formula is obtained with
2
A - 79
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
for constant strain distribution a new plate-buckling formula is obtained, that differs
from the lateral torsional buckling formula by the use of instead of
and the
100
1 Euler
2
Winter =
0.22
* (0 = 0.7 )
Column buckling
Figure 98
(10)
Figure 98 gives a comparison between the column buckling curve and the plate buckling
curve * from Figure 97 and also the Winter formula, which is quite close to the new plate
buckling formula. Both the new plate buckling formula and the winter formula are specified in
EN 1993-1-5.
9.3
(1)
Figure 99 shows the differences between the effects of constant stress distribution and
constant strain distribution resulting from imperfections for a plate without stiffeners and with
constant stress loading in case no imperfections would occur:
-
A - 80
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
101
imperfect
perfect
x x = E x
imperfect
x
x E x
Figure 99
(2)
The different effects of constant imposed stresses and constant imposed strains depend on
the aspect ratio =
a
of the plate and can be correlated with the torsion effect
b
*
crit
crit
*
where crit
is determined without torsional rigidity,
A - 81
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
102
b
+1
*
crit
a
=
crit b 2
+ 1
a
*
crit
crit
column
plate
a
b
Figure 100
(3)
Hence the torsional effect could be used as parameter for the distinction of column-likebehaviour and plate-like-behaviour for plates in a similar way as it is used for flexural
buckling and lateral-torsional buckling for girders, beams and columns.
(4)
Figure 101 shows the column curve and the Winter curve for plates in monoaxial compression
versus the aspect ratio .
It also shows the interpolation according to FEM-calculations and to the procedure given in
EN 1993-1-5.
(5)
= 0.5 1 + * 1.2 +
*
crit
crit
2 crit
+ crit
+
2
*crit
crit
*
crit
= 0.5
crit
A - 82
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
103
*
crit
crit
column
plate
Winter
column buckling
c = ( c ) (2 ) + c
cr , p
1; 0 1
cr ,c
cr , p crit
= *
cr ,c crit
Figure 101
(6)
This buckling curve is applicable to all types of plate field (un-stiffened and stiffened) and all
fields of stresses (combined x , z and ).
9.4
(1)
Cross-sections as given in Figure 102 may consist of plates, which under compression exhibit
different ultimate buckling strengths, expressed by different limit stresses Limit ,h and Limit ,b .
(2)
A - 83
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
104
resulting force
yield plateau
Figure 102
105
Figure 103
(3)
A - 84
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(4)
Figure 103 shows the strength-strain line for such a hybrid cross section:
1.
In the first phase (until the weakest plate has reached its buckling resistance Limit ,h )
the full elastic gross cross-section applies.
This is the field, where the elastic critical buckling load coefficient crit can be
calculated from the stress fields of the individual plates or the full cross-section with
gross cross-sectional properties.
The method in EN 1993-1-5 that usually limits the resistances of the cross-section to
the limit of the weakest plate field is Method 2 (section 10 in EN 1993-1-5).
2.
In the second phase further straining actions give further elastic reactions of the
stronger plate field only, until Limit ,b is reached in this field, whilst the weakest plate
yields with the resistance Limit ,h being constant.
When reaching Limit ,h the resistance of the full cross section can be determined in
three equivalent ways:
1.
2.
t eff = t
Limit ,h
Limit ,b
is chosen and the resistance is determined with the unique strength Limit ,b
and an effective cross-section with t eff for the weakest plate.
3.
beff = b
Limit ,h
Limit ,b
is chosen and the resistance is determined with the unique strength Limit ,b
and on effective cross-section with beff for the weakest plate.
3.
In a third phase further straining actions can be applied to reach the yield strain
y corresponding to f y .
This third phase does not rouse any further resistances because the two plates yield
on their resistance levels Limit ,h and Limit ,b .
However, the calculation for the resistances on the basis of effective thickness or
effective width can be referred to the yield strength f y :
t eff h = t
t effb = t
Limit ,h
fy
Limit ,b
fy
or
A - 85
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
beff h = b
beffb = b
Limit ,h
fy
Limit ,b
fy
R = Aeff f y
This method in EN 1993-1-5 is called Method 1.
(5)
Figure 104 demonstrates the differences between the phase 1-procedure (Method 2) and a
multiphase-procedure (Method 1) for the case of bending.
106
Figure 104
(6)
It is evident, that the bending resistance may be also determined for different levels of
curvature (straining Limit ) either by integration of the distribution of limiting stresses Limit or
from effective cross-sections using either effective thicknesses or effective widths.
(7)
(8)
The use of effective cross-section is preferred because of the iterative calculation of the
neutral axis (eM ) which can be carried out more easily with effective cross-sectional data.
In general Method 2 gives more conservative resistances than Method 1 due to the plastic
reserves of the hybrid-cross-section.
There is however a possibility to take plastic reserves from Load-shedding also into account
in Method 2, as illustrated in Figure 105.
A - 86
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
107
Extension of method 2
Figure 105
(9)
This requires a further step in method 2, where the increase of the moment resistances
(1)
Figure 106 shows the principles of Method 1 (use of effective cross-section) and Method 2
(use of stress-limit) as specified in EN 1993-1-5 and used in design of steel bridges.
A - 87
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
Choice of material
108
Method 2
Use of stress-limit
Figure 106
109
Method 1
Method 2
crit ,
crit ,
Ed ( x , Ed , z , Ed , Ed ) , crit
x
glob
z
crit ,
Figure 107
(2)
The procedures for the use of these methods are different as demonstrated in Figure 107:
-
In Method 1 the stress field of a plate is subdivided into 3 simplified standard fields,
for which design aids are available:
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
A verification is undertaken for each standard stress field component and the
verification for the combined stress field is carried out by an interaction formula.
In Method 2 the combined stress field is used to determine a global stress-field
amplification factor crit , to perform the stress field verification in a single step.
This method is applicable to FEM-calculations.
110
Plate-buckling coefficients
Method 1
Method 2
,
w
* ( = 0.13)
for rigid
end post
x =
z =
ult ,
crit ,
ult ,
=
crit ,
glob =
ult ,
crit ,
ult ,k
crit , global
Figure 108
(3)
Figure 108 gives the plate-buckling reduction factors for Method 1 and Method 2:
Whereas in Method 1 each standard stress field component yields a particular slenderness
and a particular buckling curve, Method 2 only uses a single global slenderness value and a
single global buckling curve * .
9.6
(1)
Figure 109 shows the various steps for the verification of an effective composite cross-section
for the standard x -field component.
A - 89
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
111
1 =
xEd
f yd
f yd =
1.0
f yk
Rd = 1.1
Rd
Reduction factor
Effective web
beff = bc =
bw
1
k = 0.43 fr = 1
1.0
Slenderness
p =
k =
p2
(for < 0 )
Effective flange
bt ,eff = b f
p 0.553(3 + )
f yk
x ,Pi
16
(1 + ) + 0.112 (1 + )2 + (1 + )
fr 1 1
Critical stress
x ,Pi = k e
e =
2 E st t 2
12b 2 1 2
Figure 109
(2)
A - 90
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
112
flexible end
post
w =
f yk
3 cr
reduction factor w
w < 0.83
0.83 w < 1.08
w 1.08
1.0
1.0
0.83 / w
0.83 / w
1.37 0.7 + w
Vbw ,Rd = w hw t w
3 =
0.83 / w
f yd
3
V Ed
Vbw ,Rd
Figure 110
(3)
Figure 110 demonstrates the check for the standard shear stress field component with the
following steps:
1.
From the critical stresses cr for the web the slenderness is determined, for which the
structural detailing of the end-post gives different shear buckling curves w .
2.
With w the shear-resistance VRd of the web can be calculated that permits to
determine the utilisation rate 3 for the -component.
(4)
The interaction formula to verify the combined stress field is based on the utilisation rates 1
and 3 and also uses parameters of the steel cross-section that describe fictitious extreme
situations of exploitation of web, see Figure 111.
A - 91
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
113
Method 1
Interaction
glob ult ,k
M
interaction
Ed
1
M f , Rd
fy
2
[23 1] 1
1 + 1
V
M pl , Rd
3 = Ed 1
VRd
1 =
Figure 111
Method 2 uses a global check instead of the interaction formula.
(5)
An example for the National Choice of Method 1 and Method 2 is given in Figure 112:
Method 1 is preferred for bridges with webs without any stiffeners or with vertical
stiffeners only, whereas Method 2 applies to multi-stiffened webs and bottom plates of
box-sections.
In particular in cases, where the elastic stress distributions at the characteristic load
level and the stress-bloc-distribution assumed at the Ultimate Limit State, give
significant differences of compression stress in the web, a serviceability limit check
with Method 2 should be applied.
A - 92
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
114
Figure 112
9.7
Design example
(1)
Figure 113 gives for the design example of a composite bridge the ultimate limit state
assessments of the cross-sections at the support P1 and at midspan, using Method 1.
115
Cross-section at support
Cross-section at midspan
stresses :
hw
= 98.5 < 109
tw
M Ed = 107.25 MNm
stresses :
M Ed = 56.1 MNm
VEd = 1.0 MN
VEd = 7.47 MN
hw
= 151 < 192
tw
stresses :
stresses :
k = 5.78
k = 5.80
hw
= 98.5 > 51
tw
cr = 112.6 MPa
w = 1.33
3 =
w = 0.675
Figure 113
A - 93
1,0
< 0.5
4.44
hw
= 151 > 51.4
tw
w = 48.2 MPa
w = 2.03
w = 0.50
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(2)
For the x -stress field component the cross-sections comply with Class 3 limits
hw
, so that
tw
For the -stress field-component the Class 3 limits are exceeded, so that a shear plate
buckling assessment using w is necessary, that gives resistances satisfying VEd .
(4)
Interaction checks are no more needed, as for the cross-section at support the web could be
fully used for shear, because the extreme resistance-value M f ,Rd satisfies M Ed , and as for
the cross-section at midspan the shear utilisation rate is below 3 = 0 ,5 , so that the
interaction is anyway satisfied.
116
176
= 0.94
+ 187.3
k = 23
k = 6
8000
= 3.13
2560
e = 19.6 MPa
crit = 2.55
crit = 1.42
1
1 + 1 +
1
1
=
+
+ 2 + 2
crit 4 cr 4 crit ,
crit , crit ,
ult ,k =
crit = 1.127
fy
E2 + 3 E
k
= 0.888
= 1.56
2
k
ult ,k
= 1.18
crit
w =
+ 2
= 0.73
Figure 114
(5)
Figure 114 gives an example for the serviceability check with Method 2 at the support P1
using extreme values of action effects at one edge. For a more accurate check the design
location xd could be used.
(6)
The critical value crit for the combined values x and could be calculated directly with the
Programme EB-Plate (CTICM); however a conservative approach is used in Figure 114.
A - 94
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
9.8
(1)
Figure 115 shows an example of a composite bridge erected by launching with a launching
nose.
117
Figure 115
118
Figure 116
A - 95
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(2)
Figure 116 gives the dimensions and edge loading of the stiffened web, that was verified on
nd
the basis of a 2 order analysis of a grid of longitudinal stiffeners and transverse strips of the
plate.
(3)
*
crit
1 and gives the moment distributions of the stiffeners as given in
crit
Figure 117.
119
Stiffener :
Webplate:
Figure 117
(4)
The addition of the effects of normal forces and bending moments for the stiffeners and the
plate strips satisfies the yield strength.
9.9
(1)
Further informations to the background and the application of the plate-buckling rules in EN
1993-1-5 may be taken from the JRC report Commentary and worked examples to EN 19931-5 Plated structural elements, see Figure 118, as well as from the DASt-Report
Entwicklung und Aufbereitung wirtschaftlicher Bemessungsregeln fr Stahl- und
Verbundtrger mit schlanken Stegblechen im Hoch- und Brckenbau (Development and
preparation of economic design rules for steel- and composite girders with slender web-plate
in buildings and bridges).
A - 96
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
133
Figure 118
10.
10.1
Fatigue rules
General
(1)
Fatigue is a typical technical area, where the large number of test results and the variety of
test interpretations requires the use of agreed technical classes and agreed verification
procedures for the standardization of the numerical fatigue assessment, so that in particular
cases discrepancies between the standard model and individual tests for a certain product
may occur.
(2)
EN 1993-1-9 gives such a classification model which is based on the following agreements:
1.
R3 N R = c3 2 10 6
is bilinear in double-logarithmic scale and represents the characteristic values (~95%fractiles) of large scale fatigue tests with constant amplitude stress ranges that
include all features of design and execution (scale effect, notches, imperfections and
discontinuities in the frame of tolerances, residual stresses) relevant for fatigue
behaviour.
The reference point c is the classification number of a detail. The classification
system includes steps of c with a factor R20 = 20 10 = 1.122 .
The value c at 2 10 6 cycles has been chosen in appreciation of Whler. The
constant amplitude endurance limit D at 5 10 6 cycles has been chosen as a
constant value for ease of use.
A - 97
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
6. DESIGN OF BRIDGE-ELEMENTS
6.2 FATIGUE RULES
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
121
Figure 119
122
Damage equivalence
D=
nEi
D = N
i
Ri
nEi
3C 2 106
3
EI
Damage equivalence:
e =
Ei3 nEi 3
n
Ei
Figure 120
A - 98
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
2.
R3 N R = c3 2 10 6
represents the damage D = 1 .
Fatigue loads represented by a spectrum of various pairs of data
Ei3 nEi
give a partial damage
D=
n Ei
=
N Ri
Ei3 n Ei
c3 2 10 6
from a linear damage accumulation and allow to calculate for the spectrum of stressranges a damage equivalent constant stress range
e = 3
3.
Ei3 n Ei
Ei
123
Reservoir-counting method
Figure 121
A - 99
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
124
Case 2
Case 3
Modified
Whler curve
for using the
Miner-rule
Figure 122
4.
For the fatigue assessment using damage equivalent stress ranges e the position
of the frequency distributions in relation to the endurance limit D for constant
amplitude stress-ranges is relevant, see Figure 122.
-
Case 1 applies where all stress ranges of the distribution are larger than the
endurance limit D from constant amplitude tests.
In this case a damage-equivalent factor can be applied to e to compare
it directly with c .
Case 2 applies where all stress ranges of the distribution are smaller than the
endurance limit D from constant amplitude tests.
In this case the comparison of e determined with the slope m requires the
use of a damage equivalent factor max .
Case 3 applies where a part of the distribution of stress ranges is larger and a
part is smaller than the endurance limit D from constant amplitude tests.
In this case it must be considered that any damage from stress ranges above
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
procedure any complication by the relationship between the -value and the
level of c could be avoided.
5.
The spectrum of stress ranges used for the fatigue assessment can either be
expressed by the damage equivalent load model from standards or from
numerical simulations of traffic effects or measurements of traffic effects.
Such spectra in general have peaks from rare heavy loads and from a large
number of small after-vibrations.
8
Whereas the cut-off-limit at 10 cycles cares for ignoring the after-vibrations,
the peak effects from heavy vehicles are normally cut-off by a limit of 1%
damage, that corresponds approximately to the definition of frequent loads or
~100 load cycles.
125
cut off
after vibrations
cut off
Figure 123
10.2
(1)
The frequency-distributions for heavy vehicles and axle distances according to Figure 124 are
suitable to develop a singular loading pattern for a damage-equivalent vehicle and to
determine the damage-equivalent values of axle load and vehicle loads as given by the
fatigue loading model FLM 3 in Figure 125.
A - 101
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
126
Figure 124
127
Detailed FLM 4
Figure 125
(2)
A - 102
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(3)
FLM 3 is in general used together with damage-equivalent factors describing the effects of
various parameters of the bridge and composition of traffic, which control the relevant fatigue
assessment.
10.3
(1)
The partial factors Ff and Mf for the fatigue assessment as recommended in EN 1993-1-9
depend on the fatigue-safety-concept, see Figure 126.
128
20
40
60
80
100
120
c
6
2 10
Mf
Ff Mf
140
Ei ) nEi
3
Ff
1
1
=
1+ n 4
Ej ) nEj
5
Ff
D
6
5 10
Mf
1
4
4
1
n=
( )5
Ff
Mf
Ff Mf = 1.0
n = 4 1 = 3
Ff Mf = 1.15
n=
Ff Mf = 1.35
4
1 1
1.155
4
n=
1 0
1.355
Figure 126
(2)
The damage tolerance concept, which is the standard concept aimed at in design,
where failure by fatigue is excluded by sufficiently early pre-warning by visible
damages like cracks so that the serviceability of the structure is infringed before
critical situations that could lead to failure may occur.
This concept requires regular inspections in service; it has the advantage, that partial
factors may be low and the service life of an existing bridge can be extended from its
target design life as long as the inspections do not produce critical adverse signals.
Figure 126 shows a way how the partial factors Ff Mf chosen for fatigue can be
associated with a safe service period
T
, defined by the total service life T and the
n+1
A - 103
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
T.
The safe-life concept, which requires that fatigue is treated as an ultimate limit state,
as pre-warning signals may not be detected sufficiently early (e.g. because of
disproportionate quick crack growth as for bolts or because access for inspection is
not possible as for tension ties buried in the soil or underwater structures).
129
Mean value m
Characteristic value: m 1.645
Design value:
Control of actions
N = 2 Mf = 5 2 = 1.15
No control of actions
Figure 127
Figure 127 shows the characteristic fatigue strength function (m 1.645 ) which for
According to the Tri-lateral Design and Analysis Code for temporary bridges the
requirements for safe-life design is also N = 2 in case the traffic loads are regularly
controlled in view of the fatigue load assumed, but it is N = 4.5 in case traffic loads
may develop with the time without control. In that case the partial factor would be
Mf = 1.35 .
In case the safe-life-concept is chosen, the structure has to be taken out of service
independently on whether inspections reveal damages or not, when the target design
life has been reached.
10.4
A - 104
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(1)
The fatigue loading model FLM 3 may be used in two ways, see Figure 128.
1.
Use as a damage equivalent vehicle together with influence surfaces for the various
lanes to determine the stress-history form the crossing over the bridge and to
calculate E 2 by using the counting method, the Miner rule and informations on
traffic distributions on lanes and design life.
In this case a single FLM 3 underestimates the fatigue effects for influence lines for
hogging moments of continuous bridges so that it should be supplemented by a
second vehicle.
2.
max and min from extreme positions of FLM 3 on the influence line for a single
lane, that is multiplied with the damage equivalent factor
= 1 2 3 4
which include all necessary informations. 1 is the span length factor that has been
determined from numerical simulations with the Auxerre-traffic and constitutes an
enveloping function versus the span length, see Figure 129.
131
Figure 129
10.5
Design example
A - 105
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
132
= 1.947
= 1.90
= 1.715
= 1.90
31.3
1
23.6
Figure 130
(1)
For the design example in Figure 130 the stress ranges = ( max min ) caused by FLM3
on extreme positions of the influence line are given.
(2)
The distribution of these stress ranges shows that at the midspans the stress ranges from
traffic action attain the largest values, whereas at the support, the stress ranges are low.
(3)
This indicates that at the supports, where thick flanges are needed, the use of high strength
steels could be appropriate, that gives small plate thicknesses and therefore economic
advantages in weld-volume.
(4)
The -values for midspan and at the supports differ a bit and vary between 1,715 and 1,947.
(5)
The fatigue assessment is carried out at two locations of the bottom flange in the field of the
side-span:
1.
2.
Further informations
(1)
Further informations on the background of the fatigue rules in EN 1993-1-9 and on design
examples is given in the JRC-Report Commentary to Eurocode 3 EN 1993 Part 1.9
Fatigue), see Figure 131.
A - 106
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
133
Figure 131
11.
11.1
General
(1)
(2)
It is therefore a purpose of this report to give this definition for steel bridges, in
particular for bridges with ropes, as stayed cable bridges.
(3)
This report also explains how the permanent action G and preloading P are treated in
nd
combinations of actions and how 2 order theory shall by applied, so that the design of e.g.
ropes and pylons in a cable stayed bridge is consistent.
11.2
Definitions
(1)
The definition of prestress and preloading may be taken from Figure 132.
Preloading is systematically used in cable-stayed bridges to optimize the distribution of action
effects for serviceability and ultimate criteria.
A - 107
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
6. DESIGN OF BRIDGE-ELEMENTS
6.3 ROPE STRUCTURES
Dissemination of information for training Vienna, 4-6 October 2010
134
Figure 132
11.3
(1)
Figure 133, Figure 134 and Figure 135 give examples for different preloading processes in
different application fields
135
Figure 133
A - 108
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
136
steel
cast of concrete
cast of concrete
composite
composite
phase 2
phase 1
Figure 134
137
5b) Prestressing of
arches by string-elements
b ow -strin g
Figure 135
A - 109
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
138
Principles
Figure 136
(2)
Due to the different aims of preloading or prestress in the various application fields it is not
possible to define preloading or prestressing in a common way.
(3)
Figure 137 and Figure 138 give examples for such different ways, prestress and preloading
are treated:
139
q 0,l =0
prestress:
q 0,l
Figure 137
A - 110
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(4)
Figure 137 shows the effect of prestressing of a concrete beam by applying imposed
displacements l to a tendon. Prestress is defined by the difference between the stress
before the imposed displacement and after.
(5)
Figure 138 shows the effect of the same displacement to a catenarian rope. The effects are
non-linear and do not permit to define the effects as a difference of stress in the rope only.
Figure 138
(6)
A - 111
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
141
Conclusion
P in EN 1990
a) preloading or prestressing process leading to a
structural shape or behaviour as required
b) prestress in specific cases where defined
Figure 139
11.4
(1)
The target of the preloading and prestressing process in the construction phase is to attain
the required structural form and distribution of effects of permanent actions and preloading
process (G + P ) , see Figure 140.
142
Target:
Figure 140
A - 112
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
(2)
Therefore calculations are carried out with characteristic values (mean values), linear material
law and stress-limitations in the cables.
143
Figure 141
(3)
in the first line the shape of a stayed structure after execution under the actions
in the second line the action effects in the various components of the structure with a
shape as indicated in the first line under the gravity loads G and the preloading P
in the third line the stress-free shape of the structural components (rope and beam)
when they are released from all actions and give their lengths and curved form as
geometrical requirements for fabrication
(G + P )
11.5
(1)
The taking in service of the structure starts with the initial geometry and initial distribution of
action effect from the actions
(G + P )
A - 113
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
144
Figure 142
(2)
For the ultimate limit state verification the various components of the structure all with a
G (G + P )
(3)
Q (Qk 1 + 0 Qk 2 )
are assumed to act on the structure with the shape resulting from (G + P ) and with an initial
load (G + P ) .
A - 114
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
145
Figure 143
(4)
the first line gives the structural shape resulting from (G + P ) with an initial loading of
components from (G + P )
-
the second line gives the design values of the additional imperfections w0 that give a
fictitious loading from
G (G + P ) + Q (Qk 1 + 0 + Qk 2 ) .
(5)
(G + P )
should represent an action from a single process and therefore have common partial factors
(G + P ) = 1,35 or
(G + P ) = 1,00
depending on unfavourable or favourable effects in combination with external loads Qk .
(6)
Where however effects of G from P are counteracting so that (G + P ) is small, e.g. at the
limit state of decompression, either G and P should be modified by G = G and
A - 115
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
146
Figure 144
12.
(1)
Gaps in the Eurocodes identified during use are being subject of the development of Non
conflicting complementary informations (NCCI).
(2)
rules for actions on bridges, e.g. treatment of combined wind-, rain- and trafficinduced vibrations
extension of rules for choice of material
stability rules for lateral torsional and plate buckling
fatigue rules
there are further items, for some of which JRC-report have already been published.
(3)
The JRC-reports Design of light-weight footbridges for human induced vibrations, see Figure
145 and Assessment of existing steel structures: Recommendations for Estimation of
Remaining Fatigue life, see Figure 146, are examples of such publications.
A - 116
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
147
Figure 145
148
Figure 146
A - 117
Appendix A: Design of steel bridges. Overview of key content of EN 1993 G. Hanswille, W. Hansen, M.
Feldmann, G. Sedlacek
A - 118
Appendix B
A sample analytical method for bearing resistance calculation - From EN 1997-2
(CEN, 2004): Annex D (informative)
D.4
Drained conditions
(D.2)
B-1
B-2
Appendix C
Example of a method to calculate the settlements for spread foundations - From
EN 1997-2 (CEN, 2004): E.2
(1) The following is an example of a method to calculate the settlement, (s), of spread foundations using a
semi-empirical method developed for MPM tests.
2 B0
9 Ed
v0
B
B0
c B
9 Ec
where
Bo
is a reference width of 0.6 m;
B
is the width of the foundation;
are shape factors given in Table E.2;
d , c
is a rheological factor given in Table E.3;
Ec
is the weighted value of EM immediately below the foundation;
Ed
is the harmonic mean of EM in all layers up to 8 B below the foundation;
is the total (initial) vertical stress at the level of the foundation base;
v0
q
is the design normal pressure applied on the foundation.
Table E.2 The shape coefficients,
L/B
d
c
c,
d,
Circle
Square
20
1
1
1.12
1.1
1.53
1.2
1.78
1.3
2.14
1.4
2.65
1.5
Description
Peat
Clay
Over-consolidated
Normally consolidated
Remoulded
16
916
79
1
0,67
0,5
Silt
Over-consolidated
Normally consolidated
>14
514
0,67
0,5
Sand
>12
512
0,5
0,33
Sand and
gravel
>10
610
0,33
0,25
Rock
Extensively fractured
Unaltered
Weathered
0,33
0,5
0,67
NOTE This example was published by the French Ministre de lEquipement du Logement et des
Transport (1993).
C-1
C-2
Appendix D: Generation of semi-artificial accelerograms for time-history analysis through modification of natural
records
Appendix D
Generation of semi-artificial accelerograms for time-history analysis through
modification of natural records
D.1 NATURAL EARTHQUAKE RECORDS
The components of the ground motions used for time-history analysis are produced by modifying natural
earthquake records in order to match the design spectrum of Eurocode 8. The natural records are from
earthquakes with magnitude, distance to fault, generation mechanism, and ground conditions compatible
as much as possible with the design seismic action for the project. In this example records from the
following earthquakes are used: Loma Prieta, USA 17/10/1989, Athens, Greece 07/09/1999, Kalamata,
Greece 10/10/1986, Pyrgos, Greece 23/4/1993, Morgan Hill, USA 24/04/1984, Gazli, USSR 17/05/1976,
Loma Prieta, USA 17/10/1989, Kobe, Japan 16/01/1995, Kocaeli, Turkey 17/08/1999, Leukada, Greece.
Appendix D: Generation of semi-artificial accelerograms for time-history analysis through modification of natural
records
0 t tm
f (t ) = 0
exp( 0 0 (t 0 t ))sin ( 0 (t 0 t ))
(D.1)
otherwise f ( t ) = 0
where:
a0
0 is a circular frequency calculated so that the response spectrum of the impulse function becomes
maximum for the circular frequency calculated in step 3 of the algorithm
0
tm
is the time value for which the maximum response occurs in accordance with step 3 of the
algorithm
t0
is a time parameter so that the response of the impulse function becomes maximum for time
equal to tm
The coefficients a0, 0, t0 are analytically calculated from lengthy functions that fulfill the requirements
presented in their definition.
After convergence of the algorithm is achieved baseline correction is applied to the produced
accelerograms in order to remove baseline trends (Boore and Bommer, 2005). These trends are well
noticeable in the displacement time-histories which may deviate significantly from the zero value for the
uncorrected accelerograms.
Baseline correction is applied as follows:
1. Determination, through regression analysis (least-squares-fit method), of the quadratic polynomial
curve that best fits the time-acceleration pairs of values.
2. Subtraction from the actual acceleration values of their corresponding counterparts as obtained
with the regression-derived equation.
In this work the modification procedure is applied to achieve compatibility with the 5%-damped design
spectra, although it is possible to apply it for a set of other damping values.
Appendix D: Generation of semi-artificial accelerograms for time-history analysis through modification of natural
records
Peak ground values of acceleration (PGA), velocity (PGV) and displacement (PGD)
,
,
Peak velocity and acceleration ratio (vmax/amax)
Acceleration (ASI) and Velocity (VSI) Spectrum Intensity [Von Thun et al., 1988]
,
Sustained maximum acceleration (SMA) and velocity (SMV)
Introduced by Nuttli [1979], this parameter gives the sustained maximum acceleration/velocity during three
cycles, and is defined as the third highest absolute value of acceleration in the time history.
Effective Design Acceleration (EDA)
This parameter corresponds to the peak acceleration value found after lowpass filtering the input time history
with a cut-off frequency of 9 Hz [Benjamin and Associates, 1988].
A95 parameter [Sarma and Yang, 1987]
The acceleration level below which 95% of the total Arias intensity is contained. In other words, if the entire
accelerogram yields a value of Ia equal to 100, the A95 parameter is the threshold of acceleration such that
integrating all the values of the accelerogram below it, one gets an Ia=95.
Predominant Period (Tp)
The predominant period (Tp) is the period at which the maximum spectral acceleration occurs in an
acceleration response spectrum calculated at 5% damping.
Mean Period (Tm)
According to Rathje et al. [1998] the mean period (Tm) is the best simplified frequency content
characterisation parameter, being estimated with the following equation, where Ci are the Fourier amplitudes,
and fi represent the discrete Fourier transform frequencies between 0.25 and 20 Hz.
Appendix D: Generation of semi-artificial accelerograms for time-history analysis through modification of natural
records
Acceleration (g)
Original Record:
0.80
0.60
0.40
0.20
0.00
-0.20
-0.40
-0.60
0
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
25
30
35
40
45
25
30
35
40
45
25
30
35
40
45
Time (sec)
Acceleration (g)
Modified Record:
0.80
0.60
0.40
0.20
0.00
-0.20
-0.40
-0.60
0
10
15
20
Time (sec)
Velocity (m/sec)
0.40
0.20
0.00
-0.20
-0.40
-0.60
-0.80
-1.00
0
10
15
20
Time (sec)
Displacement (m)
0.400
0.300
0.200
0.100
0.000
-0.100
-0.200
-0.300
0
10
15
20
Time (sec)
1.40
1.20
1.00
Damping: 5%
0.80
0.60
0.40
0.20
0.00
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
Period (sec)
0.600
Damping: 5%
0.500
Displacement (m)
0.400
0.300
0.200
0.100
0.000
0.0
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0
2.5
3.0
3.5
Period (sec)
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.5
6.0
Appendix D: Generation of semi-artificial accelerograms for time-history analysis through modification of natural
records
References
Boore, D. M. and J. J. Bommer. 2005. Processing of Strong-Motion Accelerograms: Options and
Consequences. Soil Dynamics and Earthquake Engineering 25: 93115.
Choi, D. H., and S. H. Lee. 2003. Multi-Damping Earthquake Design Spectra-Compatible Motion
Histories. Nuclear Engineering and Design 226: 22130.
Appendix D: Generation of semi-artificial accelerograms for time-history analysis through modification of natural
records
European Commission
EUR 25193 EN Joint Research Centre
Title: Bridge Design to Eurocodes Worked examples
Authors: Yosra Bouassida, Emmanuel Bouchon, Pilar Crespo, Pietro Croce, Laurence Davaine, Steve Denton,
Markus Feldmann, Roger Frank, Gerhard Hanswille, Wolfang Hensen, Basil Kolias, Nikolaos Malakatas,
Giuseppe Mancini, Miguel Ortega Cornejo, Joel Raoul, Gerhard Sedlacek, Georgios Tsionis
(Editors: Adamantia Athanasopoulou, Martin Poljansek, Artur Pinto, Georgios Tsionis, Steve Denton)
Luxembourg: Publications Office of the European Union
2012 438 pp. 21 x 29.7 cm
EUR Scientific and Technical Research series ISSN 1831-9424
ISBN 978-92-79-22823-0
doi: 10.2788/82360
Abstract
This document is a Technical Report with worked examples for a bridge structure designed following the
Eurocodes. It summarizes important points of the Eurocodes for the design of concrete, steel and composite
road bridges, including foundations and seismic design, utilizing a common bridge project as a basis.
The geometry and materials of the example bridge as well as the main assumptions and the detailed structural
calculations are presented in the first chapter of the report. Each of the subsequent chapters presents the main
principles and rules of a specific Eurocode and their application on the example bridge, namely:
The key concepts of basis of design, i.e. design situations, limit states, the single source principle and the
combinations of actions (EN 19990);
Permanent, wind, thermal, traffic and fatigue actions on the bridge deck and piers and their combinations
(EN 1991);
The design of the bridge deck and the piers for the ULS and the SLS, including the second-order effects
(EN 1992-2);
The classification of the composite cross-sections, the ULS, SLS and fatigue verifications and the detailed
design for creep and shrinkage (EN 1994-2);
The settlement and resistance calculations for the pier, three design approaches for the abutment and the
verification of the foundation for the seismic design situation (EN 1997);
The conceptual design for earthquake resistance considering the alternative solutions of slender or squat
piers; the latter case involves seismic isolation and design for ductile behavior (EN 1998-1, EN 1998-2).
The bridge worked example analyzed in this report was prepared and presented at the workshop Bridge
Design to the Eurocodes that was held on 4-6 October 2010 in Vienna, Austria. The workshop was organized
by JRC with the support of DG ENTR and in collaboration with CEN/TC250/Horizontal Group Bridges, the
Austrian Federal Ministry for Transport, Innovation and Technology and the Austrian Standards Institute.
The document is part of the Report Series Support to the implementation, harmonization and further
development of the Eurocodes, prepared by JRC in collaboration with DG ENTR and CEN/TC250 Structural
Eurocodes.
LB-NA-25193-EN-N
The mission of the JRC is to provide customer-driven scientific and technical support
for the conception, development, implementation and monitoring of EU policies. As a
service of the European Commission, the JRC functions as a reference centre of
science and technology for the Union. Close to the policy-making process, it serves
the common interest of the Member States, while being independent of special
interests, whether private or national.